diff options
Diffstat (limited to 'contrib/gcc/config/alpha/alpha.c')
-rw-r--r-- | contrib/gcc/config/alpha/alpha.c | 10308 |
1 files changed, 0 insertions, 10308 deletions
diff --git a/contrib/gcc/config/alpha/alpha.c b/contrib/gcc/config/alpha/alpha.c deleted file mode 100644 index f9aef99..0000000 --- a/contrib/gcc/config/alpha/alpha.c +++ /dev/null @@ -1,10308 +0,0 @@ -/* Subroutines used for code generation on the DEC Alpha. - Copyright (C) 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, - 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004 Free Software Foundation, Inc. - Contributed by Richard Kenner (kenner@vlsi1.ultra.nyu.edu) - -This file is part of GCC. - -GCC is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify -it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by -the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) -any later version. - -GCC is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, -but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of -MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the -GNU General Public License for more details. - -You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License -along with GCC; see the file COPYING. If not, write to -the Free Software Foundation, 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, -Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA. */ - - -#include "config.h" -#include "system.h" -#include "coretypes.h" -#include "tm.h" -#include "rtl.h" -#include "tree.h" -#include "regs.h" -#include "hard-reg-set.h" -#include "real.h" -#include "insn-config.h" -#include "conditions.h" -#include "output.h" -#include "insn-attr.h" -#include "flags.h" -#include "recog.h" -#include "expr.h" -#include "optabs.h" -#include "reload.h" -#include "obstack.h" -#include "except.h" -#include "function.h" -#include "toplev.h" -#include "ggc.h" -#include "integrate.h" -#include "tm_p.h" -#include "target.h" -#include "target-def.h" -#include "debug.h" -#include "langhooks.h" -#include <splay-tree.h> -#include "cfglayout.h" - -/* Specify which cpu to schedule for. */ - -enum processor_type alpha_cpu; -static const char * const alpha_cpu_name[] = -{ - "ev4", "ev5", "ev6" -}; - -/* Specify how accurate floating-point traps need to be. */ - -enum alpha_trap_precision alpha_tp; - -/* Specify the floating-point rounding mode. */ - -enum alpha_fp_rounding_mode alpha_fprm; - -/* Specify which things cause traps. */ - -enum alpha_fp_trap_mode alpha_fptm; - -/* Specify bit size of immediate TLS offsets. */ - -int alpha_tls_size = 32; - -/* Strings decoded into the above options. */ - -const char *alpha_cpu_string; /* -mcpu= */ -const char *alpha_tune_string; /* -mtune= */ -const char *alpha_tp_string; /* -mtrap-precision=[p|s|i] */ -const char *alpha_fprm_string; /* -mfp-rounding-mode=[n|m|c|d] */ -const char *alpha_fptm_string; /* -mfp-trap-mode=[n|u|su|sui] */ -const char *alpha_mlat_string; /* -mmemory-latency= */ -const char *alpha_tls_size_string; /* -mtls-size=[16|32|64] */ - -/* Save information from a "cmpxx" operation until the branch or scc is - emitted. */ - -struct alpha_compare alpha_compare; - -/* Nonzero if inside of a function, because the Alpha asm can't - handle .files inside of functions. */ - -static int inside_function = FALSE; - -/* The number of cycles of latency we should assume on memory reads. */ - -int alpha_memory_latency = 3; - -/* Whether the function needs the GP. */ - -static int alpha_function_needs_gp; - -/* The alias set for prologue/epilogue register save/restore. */ - -static GTY(()) int alpha_sr_alias_set; - -/* The assembler name of the current function. */ - -static const char *alpha_fnname; - -/* The next explicit relocation sequence number. */ -extern GTY(()) int alpha_next_sequence_number; -int alpha_next_sequence_number = 1; - -/* The literal and gpdisp sequence numbers for this insn, as printed - by %# and %* respectively. */ -extern GTY(()) int alpha_this_literal_sequence_number; -extern GTY(()) int alpha_this_gpdisp_sequence_number; -int alpha_this_literal_sequence_number; -int alpha_this_gpdisp_sequence_number; - -/* Costs of various operations on the different architectures. */ - -struct alpha_rtx_cost_data -{ - unsigned char fp_add; - unsigned char fp_mult; - unsigned char fp_div_sf; - unsigned char fp_div_df; - unsigned char int_mult_si; - unsigned char int_mult_di; - unsigned char int_shift; - unsigned char int_cmov; -}; - -static struct alpha_rtx_cost_data const alpha_rtx_cost_data[PROCESSOR_MAX] = -{ - { /* EV4 */ - COSTS_N_INSNS (6), /* fp_add */ - COSTS_N_INSNS (6), /* fp_mult */ - COSTS_N_INSNS (34), /* fp_div_sf */ - COSTS_N_INSNS (63), /* fp_div_df */ - COSTS_N_INSNS (23), /* int_mult_si */ - COSTS_N_INSNS (23), /* int_mult_di */ - COSTS_N_INSNS (2), /* int_shift */ - COSTS_N_INSNS (2), /* int_cmov */ - }, - { /* EV5 */ - COSTS_N_INSNS (4), /* fp_add */ - COSTS_N_INSNS (4), /* fp_mult */ - COSTS_N_INSNS (15), /* fp_div_sf */ - COSTS_N_INSNS (22), /* fp_div_df */ - COSTS_N_INSNS (8), /* int_mult_si */ - COSTS_N_INSNS (12), /* int_mult_di */ - COSTS_N_INSNS (1) + 1, /* int_shift */ - COSTS_N_INSNS (1), /* int_cmov */ - }, - { /* EV6 */ - COSTS_N_INSNS (4), /* fp_add */ - COSTS_N_INSNS (4), /* fp_mult */ - COSTS_N_INSNS (12), /* fp_div_sf */ - COSTS_N_INSNS (15), /* fp_div_df */ - COSTS_N_INSNS (7), /* int_mult_si */ - COSTS_N_INSNS (7), /* int_mult_di */ - COSTS_N_INSNS (1), /* int_shift */ - COSTS_N_INSNS (2), /* int_cmov */ - }, -}; - -/* Get the number of args of a function in one of two ways. */ -#if TARGET_ABI_OPEN_VMS || TARGET_ABI_UNICOSMK -#define NUM_ARGS current_function_args_info.num_args -#else -#define NUM_ARGS current_function_args_info -#endif - -#define REG_PV 27 -#define REG_RA 26 - -/* Declarations of static functions. */ -static struct machine_function *alpha_init_machine_status (void); -static rtx alpha_emit_xfloating_compare (enum rtx_code, rtx, rtx); - -#if TARGET_ABI_OPEN_VMS -static void alpha_write_linkage (FILE *, const char *, tree); -#endif - -static void unicosmk_output_deferred_case_vectors (FILE *); -static void unicosmk_gen_dsib (unsigned long *); -static void unicosmk_output_ssib (FILE *, const char *); -static int unicosmk_need_dex (rtx); - -/* Parse target option strings. */ - -void -override_options (void) -{ - int i; - static const struct cpu_table { - const char *const name; - const enum processor_type processor; - const int flags; - } cpu_table[] = { -#define EV5_MASK (MASK_CPU_EV5) -#define EV6_MASK (MASK_CPU_EV6|MASK_BWX|MASK_MAX|MASK_FIX) - { "ev4", PROCESSOR_EV4, 0 }, - { "ev45", PROCESSOR_EV4, 0 }, - { "21064", PROCESSOR_EV4, 0 }, - { "ev5", PROCESSOR_EV5, EV5_MASK }, - { "21164", PROCESSOR_EV5, EV5_MASK }, - { "ev56", PROCESSOR_EV5, EV5_MASK|MASK_BWX }, - { "21164a", PROCESSOR_EV5, EV5_MASK|MASK_BWX }, - { "pca56", PROCESSOR_EV5, EV5_MASK|MASK_BWX|MASK_MAX }, - { "21164PC",PROCESSOR_EV5, EV5_MASK|MASK_BWX|MASK_MAX }, - { "21164pc",PROCESSOR_EV5, EV5_MASK|MASK_BWX|MASK_MAX }, - { "ev6", PROCESSOR_EV6, EV6_MASK }, - { "21264", PROCESSOR_EV6, EV6_MASK }, - { "ev67", PROCESSOR_EV6, EV6_MASK|MASK_CIX }, - { "21264a", PROCESSOR_EV6, EV6_MASK|MASK_CIX }, - { 0, 0, 0 } - }; - - /* Unicos/Mk doesn't have shared libraries. */ - if (TARGET_ABI_UNICOSMK && flag_pic) - { - warning ("-f%s ignored for Unicos/Mk (not supported)", - (flag_pic > 1) ? "PIC" : "pic"); - flag_pic = 0; - } - - /* On Unicos/Mk, the native compiler consistently generates /d suffices for - floating-point instructions. Make that the default for this target. */ - if (TARGET_ABI_UNICOSMK) - alpha_fprm = ALPHA_FPRM_DYN; - else - alpha_fprm = ALPHA_FPRM_NORM; - - alpha_tp = ALPHA_TP_PROG; - alpha_fptm = ALPHA_FPTM_N; - - /* We cannot use su and sui qualifiers for conversion instructions on - Unicos/Mk. I'm not sure if this is due to assembler or hardware - limitations. Right now, we issue a warning if -mieee is specified - and then ignore it; eventually, we should either get it right or - disable the option altogether. */ - - if (TARGET_IEEE) - { - if (TARGET_ABI_UNICOSMK) - warning ("-mieee not supported on Unicos/Mk"); - else - { - alpha_tp = ALPHA_TP_INSN; - alpha_fptm = ALPHA_FPTM_SU; - } - } - - if (TARGET_IEEE_WITH_INEXACT) - { - if (TARGET_ABI_UNICOSMK) - warning ("-mieee-with-inexact not supported on Unicos/Mk"); - else - { - alpha_tp = ALPHA_TP_INSN; - alpha_fptm = ALPHA_FPTM_SUI; - } - } - - if (alpha_tp_string) - { - if (! strcmp (alpha_tp_string, "p")) - alpha_tp = ALPHA_TP_PROG; - else if (! strcmp (alpha_tp_string, "f")) - alpha_tp = ALPHA_TP_FUNC; - else if (! strcmp (alpha_tp_string, "i")) - alpha_tp = ALPHA_TP_INSN; - else - error ("bad value `%s' for -mtrap-precision switch", alpha_tp_string); - } - - if (alpha_fprm_string) - { - if (! strcmp (alpha_fprm_string, "n")) - alpha_fprm = ALPHA_FPRM_NORM; - else if (! strcmp (alpha_fprm_string, "m")) - alpha_fprm = ALPHA_FPRM_MINF; - else if (! strcmp (alpha_fprm_string, "c")) - alpha_fprm = ALPHA_FPRM_CHOP; - else if (! strcmp (alpha_fprm_string,"d")) - alpha_fprm = ALPHA_FPRM_DYN; - else - error ("bad value `%s' for -mfp-rounding-mode switch", - alpha_fprm_string); - } - - if (alpha_fptm_string) - { - if (strcmp (alpha_fptm_string, "n") == 0) - alpha_fptm = ALPHA_FPTM_N; - else if (strcmp (alpha_fptm_string, "u") == 0) - alpha_fptm = ALPHA_FPTM_U; - else if (strcmp (alpha_fptm_string, "su") == 0) - alpha_fptm = ALPHA_FPTM_SU; - else if (strcmp (alpha_fptm_string, "sui") == 0) - alpha_fptm = ALPHA_FPTM_SUI; - else - error ("bad value `%s' for -mfp-trap-mode switch", alpha_fptm_string); - } - - if (alpha_tls_size_string) - { - if (strcmp (alpha_tls_size_string, "16") == 0) - alpha_tls_size = 16; - else if (strcmp (alpha_tls_size_string, "32") == 0) - alpha_tls_size = 32; - else if (strcmp (alpha_tls_size_string, "64") == 0) - alpha_tls_size = 64; - else - error ("bad value `%s' for -mtls-size switch", alpha_tls_size_string); - } - - alpha_cpu - = TARGET_CPU_DEFAULT & MASK_CPU_EV6 ? PROCESSOR_EV6 - : (TARGET_CPU_DEFAULT & MASK_CPU_EV5 ? PROCESSOR_EV5 : PROCESSOR_EV4); - - if (alpha_cpu_string) - { - for (i = 0; cpu_table [i].name; i++) - if (! strcmp (alpha_cpu_string, cpu_table [i].name)) - { - alpha_cpu = cpu_table [i].processor; - target_flags &= ~ (MASK_BWX | MASK_MAX | MASK_FIX | MASK_CIX - | MASK_CPU_EV5 | MASK_CPU_EV6); - target_flags |= cpu_table [i].flags; - break; - } - if (! cpu_table [i].name) - error ("bad value `%s' for -mcpu switch", alpha_cpu_string); - } - - if (alpha_tune_string) - { - for (i = 0; cpu_table [i].name; i++) - if (! strcmp (alpha_tune_string, cpu_table [i].name)) - { - alpha_cpu = cpu_table [i].processor; - break; - } - if (! cpu_table [i].name) - error ("bad value `%s' for -mcpu switch", alpha_tune_string); - } - - /* Do some sanity checks on the above options. */ - - if (TARGET_ABI_UNICOSMK && alpha_fptm != ALPHA_FPTM_N) - { - warning ("trap mode not supported on Unicos/Mk"); - alpha_fptm = ALPHA_FPTM_N; - } - - if ((alpha_fptm == ALPHA_FPTM_SU || alpha_fptm == ALPHA_FPTM_SUI) - && alpha_tp != ALPHA_TP_INSN && ! TARGET_CPU_EV6) - { - warning ("fp software completion requires -mtrap-precision=i"); - alpha_tp = ALPHA_TP_INSN; - } - - if (TARGET_CPU_EV6) - { - /* Except for EV6 pass 1 (not released), we always have precise - arithmetic traps. Which means we can do software completion - without minding trap shadows. */ - alpha_tp = ALPHA_TP_PROG; - } - - if (TARGET_FLOAT_VAX) - { - if (alpha_fprm == ALPHA_FPRM_MINF || alpha_fprm == ALPHA_FPRM_DYN) - { - warning ("rounding mode not supported for VAX floats"); - alpha_fprm = ALPHA_FPRM_NORM; - } - if (alpha_fptm == ALPHA_FPTM_SUI) - { - warning ("trap mode not supported for VAX floats"); - alpha_fptm = ALPHA_FPTM_SU; - } - if (target_flags_explicit & MASK_LONG_DOUBLE_128) - warning ("128-bit long double not supported for VAX floats"); - target_flags &= ~MASK_LONG_DOUBLE_128; - } - - { - char *end; - int lat; - - if (!alpha_mlat_string) - alpha_mlat_string = "L1"; - - if (ISDIGIT ((unsigned char)alpha_mlat_string[0]) - && (lat = strtol (alpha_mlat_string, &end, 10), *end == '\0')) - ; - else if ((alpha_mlat_string[0] == 'L' || alpha_mlat_string[0] == 'l') - && ISDIGIT ((unsigned char)alpha_mlat_string[1]) - && alpha_mlat_string[2] == '\0') - { - static int const cache_latency[][4] = - { - { 3, 30, -1 }, /* ev4 -- Bcache is a guess */ - { 2, 12, 38 }, /* ev5 -- Bcache from PC164 LMbench numbers */ - { 3, 12, 30 }, /* ev6 -- Bcache from DS20 LMbench. */ - }; - - lat = alpha_mlat_string[1] - '0'; - if (lat <= 0 || lat > 3 || cache_latency[alpha_cpu][lat-1] == -1) - { - warning ("L%d cache latency unknown for %s", - lat, alpha_cpu_name[alpha_cpu]); - lat = 3; - } - else - lat = cache_latency[alpha_cpu][lat-1]; - } - else if (! strcmp (alpha_mlat_string, "main")) - { - /* Most current memories have about 370ns latency. This is - a reasonable guess for a fast cpu. */ - lat = 150; - } - else - { - warning ("bad value `%s' for -mmemory-latency", alpha_mlat_string); - lat = 3; - } - - alpha_memory_latency = lat; - } - - /* Default the definition of "small data" to 8 bytes. */ - if (!g_switch_set) - g_switch_value = 8; - - /* Infer TARGET_SMALL_DATA from -fpic/-fPIC. */ - if (flag_pic == 1) - target_flags |= MASK_SMALL_DATA; - else if (flag_pic == 2) - target_flags &= ~MASK_SMALL_DATA; - - /* Align labels and loops for optimal branching. */ - /* ??? Kludge these by not doing anything if we don't optimize and also if - we are writing ECOFF symbols to work around a bug in DEC's assembler. */ - if (optimize > 0 && write_symbols != SDB_DEBUG) - { - if (align_loops <= 0) - align_loops = 16; - if (align_jumps <= 0) - align_jumps = 16; - } - if (align_functions <= 0) - align_functions = 16; - - /* Acquire a unique set number for our register saves and restores. */ - alpha_sr_alias_set = new_alias_set (); - - /* Register variables and functions with the garbage collector. */ - - /* Set up function hooks. */ - init_machine_status = alpha_init_machine_status; - - /* Tell the compiler when we're using VAX floating point. */ - if (TARGET_FLOAT_VAX) - { - REAL_MODE_FORMAT (SFmode) = &vax_f_format; - REAL_MODE_FORMAT (DFmode) = &vax_g_format; - REAL_MODE_FORMAT (TFmode) = NULL; - } -} - -/* Returns 1 if VALUE is a mask that contains full bytes of zero or ones. */ - -int -zap_mask (HOST_WIDE_INT value) -{ - int i; - - for (i = 0; i < HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR; - i++, value >>= 8) - if ((value & 0xff) != 0 && (value & 0xff) != 0xff) - return 0; - - return 1; -} - -/* Returns 1 if OP is either the constant zero or a register. If a - register, it must be in the proper mode unless MODE is VOIDmode. */ - -int -reg_or_0_operand (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode) -{ - return op == CONST0_RTX (mode) || register_operand (op, mode); -} - -/* Return 1 if OP is a constant in the range of 0-63 (for a shift) or - any register. */ - -int -reg_or_6bit_operand (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode) -{ - return ((GET_CODE (op) == CONST_INT - && (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) INTVAL (op) < 64) - || register_operand (op, mode)); -} - - -/* Return 1 if OP is an 8-bit constant or any register. */ - -int -reg_or_8bit_operand (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode) -{ - return ((GET_CODE (op) == CONST_INT - && (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) INTVAL (op) < 0x100) - || register_operand (op, mode)); -} - -/* Return 1 if OP is a constant or any register. */ - -int -reg_or_const_int_operand (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode) -{ - return GET_CODE (op) == CONST_INT || register_operand (op, mode); -} - -/* Return 1 if OP is an 8-bit constant. */ - -int -cint8_operand (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED) -{ - return ((GET_CODE (op) == CONST_INT - && (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) INTVAL (op) < 0x100)); -} - -/* Return 1 if the operand is a valid second operand to an add insn. */ - -int -add_operand (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode) -{ - if (GET_CODE (op) == CONST_INT) - /* Constraints I, J, O and P are covered by K. */ - return (CONST_OK_FOR_LETTER_P (INTVAL (op), 'K') - || CONST_OK_FOR_LETTER_P (INTVAL (op), 'L')); - - return register_operand (op, mode); -} - -/* Return 1 if the operand is a valid second operand to a sign-extending - add insn. */ - -int -sext_add_operand (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode) -{ - if (GET_CODE (op) == CONST_INT) - return (CONST_OK_FOR_LETTER_P (INTVAL (op), 'I') - || CONST_OK_FOR_LETTER_P (INTVAL (op), 'O')); - - return reg_not_elim_operand (op, mode); -} - -/* Return 1 if OP is the constant 4 or 8. */ - -int -const48_operand (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED) -{ - return (GET_CODE (op) == CONST_INT - && (INTVAL (op) == 4 || INTVAL (op) == 8)); -} - -/* Return 1 if OP is a valid first operand to an AND insn. */ - -int -and_operand (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode) -{ - if (GET_CODE (op) == CONST_DOUBLE && GET_MODE (op) == VOIDmode) - return (zap_mask (CONST_DOUBLE_LOW (op)) - && zap_mask (CONST_DOUBLE_HIGH (op))); - - if (GET_CODE (op) == CONST_INT) - return ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) INTVAL (op) < 0x100 - || (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) ~ INTVAL (op) < 0x100 - || zap_mask (INTVAL (op))); - - return register_operand (op, mode); -} - -/* Return 1 if OP is a valid first operand to an IOR or XOR insn. */ - -int -or_operand (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode) -{ - if (GET_CODE (op) == CONST_INT) - return ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) INTVAL (op) < 0x100 - || (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) ~ INTVAL (op) < 0x100); - - return register_operand (op, mode); -} - -/* Return 1 if OP is a constant that is the width, in bits, of an integral - mode smaller than DImode. */ - -int -mode_width_operand (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED) -{ - return (GET_CODE (op) == CONST_INT - && (INTVAL (op) == 8 || INTVAL (op) == 16 - || INTVAL (op) == 32 || INTVAL (op) == 64)); -} - -/* Return 1 if OP is a constant that is the width of an integral machine mode - smaller than an integer. */ - -int -mode_mask_operand (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED) -{ - if (GET_CODE (op) == CONST_INT) - { - HOST_WIDE_INT value = INTVAL (op); - - if (value == 0xff) - return 1; - if (value == 0xffff) - return 1; - if (value == 0xffffffff) - return 1; - if (value == -1) - return 1; - } - else if (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 32 && GET_CODE (op) == CONST_DOUBLE) - { - if (CONST_DOUBLE_LOW (op) == 0xffffffff && CONST_DOUBLE_HIGH (op) == 0) - return 1; - } - - return 0; -} - -/* Return 1 if OP is a multiple of 8 less than 64. */ - -int -mul8_operand (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED) -{ - return (GET_CODE (op) == CONST_INT - && (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) INTVAL (op) < 64 - && (INTVAL (op) & 7) == 0); -} - -/* Return 1 if OP is the zero constant for MODE. */ - -int -const0_operand (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode) -{ - return op == CONST0_RTX (mode); -} - -/* Return 1 if OP is a hard floating-point register. */ - -int -hard_fp_register_operand (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode) -{ - if (mode != VOIDmode && GET_MODE (op) != VOIDmode && mode != GET_MODE (op)) - return 0; - - if (GET_CODE (op) == SUBREG) - op = SUBREG_REG (op); - return GET_CODE (op) == REG && REGNO_REG_CLASS (REGNO (op)) == FLOAT_REGS; -} - -/* Return 1 if OP is a hard general register. */ - -int -hard_int_register_operand (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode) -{ - if (mode != VOIDmode && GET_MODE (op) != VOIDmode && mode != GET_MODE (op)) - return 0; - - if (GET_CODE (op) == SUBREG) - op = SUBREG_REG (op); - return GET_CODE (op) == REG && REGNO_REG_CLASS (REGNO (op)) == GENERAL_REGS; -} - -/* Return 1 if OP is a register or a constant integer. */ - - -int -reg_or_cint_operand (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode) -{ - return (GET_CODE (op) == CONST_INT - || register_operand (op, mode)); -} - -/* Return 1 if OP is something that can be reloaded into a register; - if it is a MEM, it need not be valid. */ - -int -some_operand (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode) -{ - if (mode != VOIDmode && GET_MODE (op) != VOIDmode && mode != GET_MODE (op)) - return 0; - - switch (GET_CODE (op)) - { - case REG: - case MEM: - case CONST_INT: - case CONST_DOUBLE: - case CONST_VECTOR: - case LABEL_REF: - case SYMBOL_REF: - case CONST: - case HIGH: - return 1; - - case SUBREG: - return some_operand (SUBREG_REG (op), VOIDmode); - - default: - break; - } - - return 0; -} - -/* Likewise, but don't accept constants. */ - -int -some_ni_operand (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode) -{ - if (GET_MODE (op) != mode && mode != VOIDmode) - return 0; - - if (GET_CODE (op) == SUBREG) - op = SUBREG_REG (op); - - return (GET_CODE (op) == REG || GET_CODE (op) == MEM); -} - -/* Return 1 if OP is a valid operand for the source of a move insn. */ - -int -input_operand (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode) -{ - if (mode != VOIDmode && GET_MODE (op) != VOIDmode && mode != GET_MODE (op)) - return 0; - - if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_FLOAT && GET_MODE (op) != mode) - return 0; - - switch (GET_CODE (op)) - { - case LABEL_REF: - case SYMBOL_REF: - case CONST: - if (TARGET_EXPLICIT_RELOCS) - { - /* We don't split symbolic operands into something unintelligable - until after reload, but we do not wish non-small, non-global - symbolic operands to be reconstructed from their high/lo_sum - form. */ - return (small_symbolic_operand (op, mode) - || global_symbolic_operand (op, mode) - || gotdtp_symbolic_operand (op, mode) - || gottp_symbolic_operand (op, mode)); - } - - /* This handles both the Windows/NT and OSF cases. */ - return mode == ptr_mode || mode == DImode; - - case HIGH: - return (TARGET_EXPLICIT_RELOCS - && local_symbolic_operand (XEXP (op, 0), mode)); - - case REG: - case ADDRESSOF: - return 1; - - case SUBREG: - if (register_operand (op, mode)) - return 1; - /* ... fall through ... */ - case MEM: - return ((TARGET_BWX || (mode != HImode && mode != QImode)) - && general_operand (op, mode)); - - case CONST_DOUBLE: - case CONST_VECTOR: - return op == CONST0_RTX (mode); - - case CONST_INT: - return mode == QImode || mode == HImode || add_operand (op, mode); - - case CONSTANT_P_RTX: - return 1; - - default: - break; - } - - return 0; -} - -/* Return 1 if OP is a SYMBOL_REF for a function known to be in this - file, and in the same section as the current function. */ - -int -samegp_function_operand (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED) -{ - if (GET_CODE (op) != SYMBOL_REF) - return false; - - /* Easy test for recursion. */ - if (op == XEXP (DECL_RTL (current_function_decl), 0)) - return true; - - /* Functions that are not local can be overridden, and thus may - not share the same gp. */ - if (! SYMBOL_REF_LOCAL_P (op)) - return false; - - /* If -msmall-data is in effect, assume that there is only one GP - for the module, and so any local symbol has this property. We - need explicit relocations to be able to enforce this for symbols - not defined in this unit of translation, however. */ - if (TARGET_EXPLICIT_RELOCS && TARGET_SMALL_DATA) - return true; - - /* Functions that are not external are defined in this UoT, - and thus must share the same gp. */ - return ! SYMBOL_REF_EXTERNAL_P (op); -} - -/* Return 1 if OP is a SYMBOL_REF for which we can make a call via bsr. */ - -int -direct_call_operand (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode) -{ - tree op_decl, cfun_sec, op_sec; - - /* Must share the same GP. */ - if (!samegp_function_operand (op, mode)) - return false; - - /* If profiling is implemented via linker tricks, we can't jump - to the nogp alternate entry point. Note that current_function_profile - would not be correct, since that doesn't indicate if the target - function uses profiling. */ - /* ??? TARGET_PROFILING_NEEDS_GP isn't really the right test, - but is approximately correct for the OSF ABIs. Don't know - what to do for VMS, NT, or UMK. */ - if (!TARGET_PROFILING_NEEDS_GP && profile_flag) - return false; - - /* Must be a function. In some cases folks create thunks in static - data structures and then make calls to them. If we allow the - direct call, we'll get an error from the linker about !samegp reloc - against a symbol without a .prologue directive. */ - if (!SYMBOL_REF_FUNCTION_P (op)) - return false; - - /* Must be "near" so that the branch is assumed to reach. With - -msmall-text, this is assumed true of all local symbols. Since - we've already checked samegp, locality is already assured. */ - if (TARGET_SMALL_TEXT) - return true; - - /* Otherwise, a decl is "near" if it is defined in the same section. */ - if (flag_function_sections) - return false; - - op_decl = SYMBOL_REF_DECL (op); - if (DECL_ONE_ONLY (current_function_decl) - || (op_decl && DECL_ONE_ONLY (op_decl))) - return false; - - cfun_sec = DECL_SECTION_NAME (current_function_decl); - op_sec = op_decl ? DECL_SECTION_NAME (op_decl) : NULL; - return ((!cfun_sec && !op_sec) - || (cfun_sec && op_sec - && strcmp (TREE_STRING_POINTER (cfun_sec), - TREE_STRING_POINTER (op_sec)) == 0)); -} - -/* Return true if OP is a LABEL_REF, or SYMBOL_REF or CONST referencing - a (non-tls) variable known to be defined in this file. */ - -int -local_symbolic_operand (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode) -{ - if (mode != VOIDmode && GET_MODE (op) != VOIDmode && mode != GET_MODE (op)) - return 0; - - if (GET_CODE (op) == LABEL_REF) - return 1; - - if (GET_CODE (op) == CONST - && GET_CODE (XEXP (op, 0)) == PLUS - && GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (op, 0), 1)) == CONST_INT) - op = XEXP (XEXP (op, 0), 0); - - if (GET_CODE (op) != SYMBOL_REF) - return 0; - - return SYMBOL_REF_LOCAL_P (op) && !SYMBOL_REF_TLS_MODEL (op); -} - -/* Return true if OP is a SYMBOL_REF or CONST referencing a variable - known to be defined in this file in the small data area. */ - -int -small_symbolic_operand (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED) -{ - if (! TARGET_SMALL_DATA) - return 0; - - if (mode != VOIDmode && GET_MODE (op) != VOIDmode && mode != GET_MODE (op)) - return 0; - - if (GET_CODE (op) == CONST - && GET_CODE (XEXP (op, 0)) == PLUS - && GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (op, 0), 1)) == CONST_INT) - op = XEXP (XEXP (op, 0), 0); - - if (GET_CODE (op) != SYMBOL_REF) - return 0; - - /* ??? There's no encode_section_info equivalent for the rtl - constant pool, so SYMBOL_FLAG_SMALL never gets set. */ - if (CONSTANT_POOL_ADDRESS_P (op)) - return GET_MODE_SIZE (get_pool_mode (op)) <= g_switch_value; - - return (SYMBOL_REF_LOCAL_P (op) - && SYMBOL_REF_SMALL_P (op) - && SYMBOL_REF_TLS_MODEL (op) == 0); -} - -/* Return true if OP is a SYMBOL_REF or CONST referencing a variable - not known (or known not) to be defined in this file. */ - -int -global_symbolic_operand (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode) -{ - if (mode != VOIDmode && GET_MODE (op) != VOIDmode && mode != GET_MODE (op)) - return 0; - - if (GET_CODE (op) == CONST - && GET_CODE (XEXP (op, 0)) == PLUS - && GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (op, 0), 1)) == CONST_INT) - op = XEXP (XEXP (op, 0), 0); - - if (GET_CODE (op) != SYMBOL_REF) - return 0; - - return !SYMBOL_REF_LOCAL_P (op) && !SYMBOL_REF_TLS_MODEL (op); -} - -/* Return 1 if OP is a valid operand for the MEM of a CALL insn. */ - -int -call_operand (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode) -{ - if (mode != Pmode) - return 0; - - if (GET_CODE (op) == REG) - { - if (TARGET_ABI_OSF) - { - /* Disallow virtual registers to cope with pathological test cases - such as compile/930117-1.c in which the virtual reg decomposes - to the frame pointer. Which is a hard reg that is not $27. */ - return (REGNO (op) == 27 || REGNO (op) > LAST_VIRTUAL_REGISTER); - } - else - return 1; - } - if (TARGET_ABI_UNICOSMK) - return 0; - if (GET_CODE (op) == SYMBOL_REF) - return 1; - - return 0; -} - -/* Returns 1 if OP is a symbolic operand, i.e. a symbol_ref or a label_ref, - possibly with an offset. */ - -int -symbolic_operand (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode) -{ - if (mode != VOIDmode && GET_MODE (op) != VOIDmode && mode != GET_MODE (op)) - return 0; - if (GET_CODE (op) == SYMBOL_REF || GET_CODE (op) == LABEL_REF) - return 1; - if (GET_CODE (op) == CONST - && GET_CODE (XEXP (op,0)) == PLUS - && GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (op,0), 0)) == SYMBOL_REF - && GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (op,0), 1)) == CONST_INT) - return 1; - return 0; -} - -/* Return true if OP is valid for a particular TLS relocation. */ - -static int -tls_symbolic_operand_1 (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode, int size, int unspec) -{ - if (mode != VOIDmode && GET_MODE (op) != VOIDmode && mode != GET_MODE (op)) - return 0; - - if (GET_CODE (op) != CONST) - return 0; - op = XEXP (op, 0); - - if (GET_CODE (op) != UNSPEC || XINT (op, 1) != unspec) - return 0; - op = XVECEXP (op, 0, 0); - - if (GET_CODE (op) != SYMBOL_REF) - return 0; - - if (SYMBOL_REF_LOCAL_P (op)) - { - if (alpha_tls_size > size) - return 0; - } - else - { - if (size != 64) - return 0; - } - - switch (SYMBOL_REF_TLS_MODEL (op)) - { - case TLS_MODEL_LOCAL_DYNAMIC: - return unspec == UNSPEC_DTPREL; - case TLS_MODEL_INITIAL_EXEC: - return unspec == UNSPEC_TPREL && size == 64; - case TLS_MODEL_LOCAL_EXEC: - return unspec == UNSPEC_TPREL; - default: - abort (); - } -} - -/* Return true if OP is valid for 16-bit DTP relative relocations. */ - -int -dtp16_symbolic_operand (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode) -{ - return tls_symbolic_operand_1 (op, mode, 16, UNSPEC_DTPREL); -} - -/* Return true if OP is valid for 32-bit DTP relative relocations. */ - -int -dtp32_symbolic_operand (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode) -{ - return tls_symbolic_operand_1 (op, mode, 32, UNSPEC_DTPREL); -} - -/* Return true if OP is valid for 64-bit DTP relative relocations. */ - -int -gotdtp_symbolic_operand (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode) -{ - return tls_symbolic_operand_1 (op, mode, 64, UNSPEC_DTPREL); -} - -/* Return true if OP is valid for 16-bit TP relative relocations. */ - -int -tp16_symbolic_operand (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode) -{ - return tls_symbolic_operand_1 (op, mode, 16, UNSPEC_TPREL); -} - -/* Return true if OP is valid for 32-bit TP relative relocations. */ - -int -tp32_symbolic_operand (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode) -{ - return tls_symbolic_operand_1 (op, mode, 32, UNSPEC_TPREL); -} - -/* Return true if OP is valid for 64-bit TP relative relocations. */ - -int -gottp_symbolic_operand (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode) -{ - return tls_symbolic_operand_1 (op, mode, 64, UNSPEC_TPREL); -} - -/* Return 1 if OP is a valid Alpha comparison operator. Here we know which - comparisons are valid in which insn. */ - -int -alpha_comparison_operator (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode) -{ - enum rtx_code code = GET_CODE (op); - - if (mode != GET_MODE (op) && mode != VOIDmode) - return 0; - - return (code == EQ || code == LE || code == LT - || code == LEU || code == LTU); -} - -/* Return 1 if OP is a valid Alpha comparison operator against zero. - Here we know which comparisons are valid in which insn. */ - -int -alpha_zero_comparison_operator (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode) -{ - enum rtx_code code = GET_CODE (op); - - if (mode != GET_MODE (op) && mode != VOIDmode) - return 0; - - return (code == EQ || code == NE || code == LE || code == LT - || code == LEU || code == LTU); -} - -/* Return 1 if OP is a valid Alpha swapped comparison operator. */ - -int -alpha_swapped_comparison_operator (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode) -{ - enum rtx_code code = GET_CODE (op); - - if ((mode != GET_MODE (op) && mode != VOIDmode) - || GET_RTX_CLASS (code) != '<') - return 0; - - code = swap_condition (code); - return (code == EQ || code == LE || code == LT - || code == LEU || code == LTU); -} - -/* Return 1 if OP is a signed comparison operation. */ - -int -signed_comparison_operator (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED) -{ - enum rtx_code code = GET_CODE (op); - - if (mode != GET_MODE (op) && mode != VOIDmode) - return 0; - - return (code == EQ || code == NE - || code == LE || code == LT - || code == GE || code == GT); -} - -/* Return 1 if OP is a valid Alpha floating point comparison operator. - Here we know which comparisons are valid in which insn. */ - -int -alpha_fp_comparison_operator (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode) -{ - enum rtx_code code = GET_CODE (op); - - if (mode != GET_MODE (op) && mode != VOIDmode) - return 0; - - return (code == EQ || code == LE || code == LT || code == UNORDERED); -} - -/* Return 1 if this is a divide or modulus operator. */ - -int -divmod_operator (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED) -{ - enum rtx_code code = GET_CODE (op); - - return (code == DIV || code == MOD || code == UDIV || code == UMOD); -} - -/* Return 1 if this is a float->int conversion operator. */ - -int -fix_operator (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED) -{ - enum rtx_code code = GET_CODE (op); - - return (code == FIX || code == UNSIGNED_FIX); -} - -/* Return 1 if this memory address is a known aligned register plus - a constant. It must be a valid address. This means that we can do - this as an aligned reference plus some offset. - - Take into account what reload will do. */ - -int -aligned_memory_operand (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode) -{ - rtx base; - - if (reload_in_progress) - { - rtx tmp = op; - if (GET_CODE (tmp) == SUBREG) - tmp = SUBREG_REG (tmp); - if (GET_CODE (tmp) == REG - && REGNO (tmp) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER) - { - op = reg_equiv_memory_loc[REGNO (tmp)]; - if (op == 0) - return 0; - } - } - - if (GET_CODE (op) != MEM) - return 0; - if (MEM_ALIGN (op) >= 32) - return 1; - op = XEXP (op, 0); - - /* LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS creates (plus (plus reg const_hi) const_lo) - sorts of constructs. Dig for the real base register. */ - if (reload_in_progress - && GET_CODE (op) == PLUS - && GET_CODE (XEXP (op, 0)) == PLUS) - base = XEXP (XEXP (op, 0), 0); - else - { - if (! memory_address_p (mode, op)) - return 0; - base = (GET_CODE (op) == PLUS ? XEXP (op, 0) : op); - } - - return (GET_CODE (base) == REG && REGNO_POINTER_ALIGN (REGNO (base)) >= 32); -} - -/* Similar, but return 1 if OP is a MEM which is not alignable. */ - -int -unaligned_memory_operand (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode) -{ - rtx base; - - if (reload_in_progress) - { - rtx tmp = op; - if (GET_CODE (tmp) == SUBREG) - tmp = SUBREG_REG (tmp); - if (GET_CODE (tmp) == REG - && REGNO (tmp) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER) - { - op = reg_equiv_memory_loc[REGNO (tmp)]; - if (op == 0) - return 0; - } - } - - if (GET_CODE (op) != MEM) - return 0; - if (MEM_ALIGN (op) >= 32) - return 0; - op = XEXP (op, 0); - - /* LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS creates (plus (plus reg const_hi) const_lo) - sorts of constructs. Dig for the real base register. */ - if (reload_in_progress - && GET_CODE (op) == PLUS - && GET_CODE (XEXP (op, 0)) == PLUS) - base = XEXP (XEXP (op, 0), 0); - else - { - if (! memory_address_p (mode, op)) - return 0; - base = (GET_CODE (op) == PLUS ? XEXP (op, 0) : op); - } - - return (GET_CODE (base) == REG && REGNO_POINTER_ALIGN (REGNO (base)) < 32); -} - -/* Return 1 if OP is either a register or an unaligned memory location. */ - -int -reg_or_unaligned_mem_operand (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode) -{ - return register_operand (op, mode) || unaligned_memory_operand (op, mode); -} - -/* Return 1 if OP is any memory location. During reload a pseudo matches. */ - -int -any_memory_operand (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED) -{ - return (GET_CODE (op) == MEM - || (GET_CODE (op) == SUBREG && GET_CODE (SUBREG_REG (op)) == REG) - || (reload_in_progress && GET_CODE (op) == REG - && REGNO (op) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER) - || (reload_in_progress && GET_CODE (op) == SUBREG - && GET_CODE (SUBREG_REG (op)) == REG - && REGNO (SUBREG_REG (op)) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)); -} - -/* Returns 1 if OP is not an eliminable register. - - This exists to cure a pathological abort in the s8addq (et al) patterns, - - long foo () { long t; bar(); return (long) &t * 26107; } - - which run afoul of a hack in reload to cure a (presumably) similar - problem with lea-type instructions on other targets. But there is - one of us and many of them, so work around the problem by selectively - preventing combine from making the optimization. */ - -int -reg_not_elim_operand (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode) -{ - rtx inner = op; - if (GET_CODE (op) == SUBREG) - inner = SUBREG_REG (op); - if (inner == frame_pointer_rtx || inner == arg_pointer_rtx) - return 0; - - return register_operand (op, mode); -} - -/* Return 1 is OP is a memory location that is not a reference (using - an AND) to an unaligned location. Take into account what reload - will do. */ - -int -normal_memory_operand (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED) -{ - if (reload_in_progress) - { - rtx tmp = op; - if (GET_CODE (tmp) == SUBREG) - tmp = SUBREG_REG (tmp); - if (GET_CODE (tmp) == REG - && REGNO (tmp) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER) - { - op = reg_equiv_memory_loc[REGNO (tmp)]; - - /* This may not have been assigned an equivalent address if it will - be eliminated. In that case, it doesn't matter what we do. */ - if (op == 0) - return 1; - } - } - - return GET_CODE (op) == MEM && GET_CODE (XEXP (op, 0)) != AND; -} - -/* Accept a register, but not a subreg of any kind. This allows us to - avoid pathological cases in reload wrt data movement common in - int->fp conversion. */ - -int -reg_no_subreg_operand (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode) -{ - if (GET_CODE (op) != REG) - return 0; - return register_operand (op, mode); -} - -/* Recognize an addition operation that includes a constant. Used to - convince reload to canonize (plus (plus reg c1) c2) during register - elimination. */ - -int -addition_operation (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode) -{ - if (GET_MODE (op) != mode && mode != VOIDmode) - return 0; - if (GET_CODE (op) == PLUS - && register_operand (XEXP (op, 0), mode) - && GET_CODE (XEXP (op, 1)) == CONST_INT - && CONST_OK_FOR_LETTER_P (INTVAL (XEXP (op, 1)), 'K')) - return 1; - return 0; -} - -/* Implements CONST_OK_FOR_LETTER_P. Return true if the value matches - the range defined for C in [I-P]. */ - -bool -alpha_const_ok_for_letter_p (HOST_WIDE_INT value, int c) -{ - switch (c) - { - case 'I': - /* An unsigned 8 bit constant. */ - return (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) value < 0x100; - case 'J': - /* The constant zero. */ - return value == 0; - case 'K': - /* A signed 16 bit constant. */ - return (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) (value + 0x8000) < 0x10000; - case 'L': - /* A shifted signed 16 bit constant appropriate for LDAH. */ - return ((value & 0xffff) == 0 - && ((value) >> 31 == -1 || value >> 31 == 0)); - case 'M': - /* A constant that can be AND'ed with using a ZAP insn. */ - return zap_mask (value); - case 'N': - /* A complemented unsigned 8 bit constant. */ - return (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) (~ value) < 0x100; - case 'O': - /* A negated unsigned 8 bit constant. */ - return (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) (- value) < 0x100; - case 'P': - /* The constant 1, 2 or 3. */ - return value == 1 || value == 2 || value == 3; - - default: - return false; - } -} - -/* Implements CONST_DOUBLE_OK_FOR_LETTER_P. Return true if VALUE - matches for C in [GH]. */ - -bool -alpha_const_double_ok_for_letter_p (rtx value, int c) -{ - switch (c) - { - case 'G': - /* The floating point zero constant. */ - return (GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (value)) == MODE_FLOAT - && value == CONST0_RTX (GET_MODE (value))); - - case 'H': - /* A valid operand of a ZAP insn. */ - return (GET_MODE (value) == VOIDmode - && zap_mask (CONST_DOUBLE_LOW (value)) - && zap_mask (CONST_DOUBLE_HIGH (value))); - - default: - return false; - } -} - -/* Implements CONST_DOUBLE_OK_FOR_LETTER_P. Return true if VALUE - matches for C. */ - -bool -alpha_extra_constraint (rtx value, int c) -{ - switch (c) - { - case 'Q': - return normal_memory_operand (value, VOIDmode); - case 'R': - return direct_call_operand (value, Pmode); - case 'S': - return (GET_CODE (value) == CONST_INT - && (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) INTVAL (value) < 64); - case 'T': - return GET_CODE (value) == HIGH; - case 'U': - return TARGET_ABI_UNICOSMK && symbolic_operand (value, VOIDmode); - case 'W': - return (GET_CODE (value) == CONST_VECTOR - && value == CONST0_RTX (GET_MODE (value))); - default: - return false; - } -} - -/* Return 1 if this function can directly return via $26. */ - -int -direct_return (void) -{ - return (! TARGET_ABI_OPEN_VMS && ! TARGET_ABI_UNICOSMK - && reload_completed - && alpha_sa_size () == 0 - && get_frame_size () == 0 - && current_function_outgoing_args_size == 0 - && current_function_pretend_args_size == 0); -} - -/* Return the ADDR_VEC associated with a tablejump insn. */ - -rtx -alpha_tablejump_addr_vec (rtx insn) -{ - rtx tmp; - - tmp = JUMP_LABEL (insn); - if (!tmp) - return NULL_RTX; - tmp = NEXT_INSN (tmp); - if (!tmp) - return NULL_RTX; - if (GET_CODE (tmp) == JUMP_INSN - && GET_CODE (PATTERN (tmp)) == ADDR_DIFF_VEC) - return PATTERN (tmp); - return NULL_RTX; -} - -/* Return the label of the predicted edge, or CONST0_RTX if we don't know. */ - -rtx -alpha_tablejump_best_label (rtx insn) -{ - rtx jump_table = alpha_tablejump_addr_vec (insn); - rtx best_label = NULL_RTX; - - /* ??? Once the CFG doesn't keep getting completely rebuilt, look - there for edge frequency counts from profile data. */ - - if (jump_table) - { - int n_labels = XVECLEN (jump_table, 1); - int best_count = -1; - int i, j; - - for (i = 0; i < n_labels; i++) - { - int count = 1; - - for (j = i + 1; j < n_labels; j++) - if (XEXP (XVECEXP (jump_table, 1, i), 0) - == XEXP (XVECEXP (jump_table, 1, j), 0)) - count++; - - if (count > best_count) - best_count = count, best_label = XVECEXP (jump_table, 1, i); - } - } - - return best_label ? best_label : const0_rtx; -} - -/* Return the TLS model to use for SYMBOL. */ - -static enum tls_model -tls_symbolic_operand_type (rtx symbol) -{ - enum tls_model model; - - if (GET_CODE (symbol) != SYMBOL_REF) - return 0; - model = SYMBOL_REF_TLS_MODEL (symbol); - - /* Local-exec with a 64-bit size is the same code as initial-exec. */ - if (model == TLS_MODEL_LOCAL_EXEC && alpha_tls_size == 64) - model = TLS_MODEL_INITIAL_EXEC; - - return model; -} - -/* Return true if the function DECL will share the same GP as any - function in the current unit of translation. */ - -static bool -decl_has_samegp (tree decl) -{ - /* Functions that are not local can be overridden, and thus may - not share the same gp. */ - if (!(*targetm.binds_local_p) (decl)) - return false; - - /* If -msmall-data is in effect, assume that there is only one GP - for the module, and so any local symbol has this property. We - need explicit relocations to be able to enforce this for symbols - not defined in this unit of translation, however. */ - if (TARGET_EXPLICIT_RELOCS && TARGET_SMALL_DATA) - return true; - - /* Functions that are not external are defined in this UoT. */ - /* ??? Irritatingly, static functions not yet emitted are still - marked "external". Apply this to non-static functions only. */ - return !TREE_PUBLIC (decl) || !DECL_EXTERNAL (decl); -} - -/* Return true if EXP should be placed in the small data section. */ - -static bool -alpha_in_small_data_p (tree exp) -{ - /* We want to merge strings, so we never consider them small data. */ - if (TREE_CODE (exp) == STRING_CST) - return false; - - /* Functions are never in the small data area. Duh. */ - if (TREE_CODE (exp) == FUNCTION_DECL) - return false; - - if (TREE_CODE (exp) == VAR_DECL && DECL_SECTION_NAME (exp)) - { - const char *section = TREE_STRING_POINTER (DECL_SECTION_NAME (exp)); - if (strcmp (section, ".sdata") == 0 - || strcmp (section, ".sbss") == 0) - return true; - } - else - { - HOST_WIDE_INT size = int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (exp)); - - /* If this is an incomplete type with size 0, then we can't put it - in sdata because it might be too big when completed. */ - if (size > 0 && (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) size <= g_switch_value) - return true; - } - - return false; -} - -#if TARGET_ABI_OPEN_VMS -static bool -alpha_linkage_symbol_p (const char *symname) -{ - int symlen = strlen (symname); - - if (symlen > 4) - return strcmp (&symname [symlen - 4], "..lk") == 0; - - return false; -} - -#define LINKAGE_SYMBOL_REF_P(X) \ - ((GET_CODE (X) == SYMBOL_REF \ - && alpha_linkage_symbol_p (XSTR (X, 0))) \ - || (GET_CODE (X) == CONST \ - && GET_CODE (XEXP (X, 0)) == PLUS \ - && GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (X, 0), 0)) == SYMBOL_REF \ - && alpha_linkage_symbol_p (XSTR (XEXP (XEXP (X, 0), 0), 0)))) -#endif - -/* legitimate_address_p recognizes an RTL expression that is a valid - memory address for an instruction. The MODE argument is the - machine mode for the MEM expression that wants to use this address. - - For Alpha, we have either a constant address or the sum of a - register and a constant address, or just a register. For DImode, - any of those forms can be surrounded with an AND that clear the - low-order three bits; this is an "unaligned" access. */ - -bool -alpha_legitimate_address_p (enum machine_mode mode, rtx x, int strict) -{ - /* If this is an ldq_u type address, discard the outer AND. */ - if (mode == DImode - && GET_CODE (x) == AND - && GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 1)) == CONST_INT - && INTVAL (XEXP (x, 1)) == -8) - x = XEXP (x, 0); - - /* Discard non-paradoxical subregs. */ - if (GET_CODE (x) == SUBREG - && (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x)) - < GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (x))))) - x = SUBREG_REG (x); - - /* Unadorned general registers are valid. */ - if (REG_P (x) - && (strict - ? STRICT_REG_OK_FOR_BASE_P (x) - : NONSTRICT_REG_OK_FOR_BASE_P (x))) - return true; - - /* Constant addresses (i.e. +/- 32k) are valid. */ - if (CONSTANT_ADDRESS_P (x)) - return true; - -#if TARGET_ABI_OPEN_VMS - if (LINKAGE_SYMBOL_REF_P (x)) - return true; -#endif - - /* Register plus a small constant offset is valid. */ - if (GET_CODE (x) == PLUS) - { - rtx ofs = XEXP (x, 1); - x = XEXP (x, 0); - - /* Discard non-paradoxical subregs. */ - if (GET_CODE (x) == SUBREG - && (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x)) - < GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (x))))) - x = SUBREG_REG (x); - - if (REG_P (x)) - { - if (! strict - && NONSTRICT_REG_OK_FP_BASE_P (x) - && GET_CODE (ofs) == CONST_INT) - return true; - if ((strict - ? STRICT_REG_OK_FOR_BASE_P (x) - : NONSTRICT_REG_OK_FOR_BASE_P (x)) - && CONSTANT_ADDRESS_P (ofs)) - return true; - } - else if (GET_CODE (x) == ADDRESSOF - && GET_CODE (ofs) == CONST_INT) - return true; - } - - /* If we're managing explicit relocations, LO_SUM is valid, as - are small data symbols. */ - else if (TARGET_EXPLICIT_RELOCS) - { - if (small_symbolic_operand (x, Pmode)) - return true; - - if (GET_CODE (x) == LO_SUM) - { - rtx ofs = XEXP (x, 1); - x = XEXP (x, 0); - - /* Discard non-paradoxical subregs. */ - if (GET_CODE (x) == SUBREG - && (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x)) - < GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (x))))) - x = SUBREG_REG (x); - - /* Must have a valid base register. */ - if (! (REG_P (x) - && (strict - ? STRICT_REG_OK_FOR_BASE_P (x) - : NONSTRICT_REG_OK_FOR_BASE_P (x)))) - return false; - - /* The symbol must be local. */ - if (local_symbolic_operand (ofs, Pmode) - || dtp32_symbolic_operand (ofs, Pmode) - || tp32_symbolic_operand (ofs, Pmode)) - return true; - } - } - - return false; -} - -/* Build the SYMBOL_REF for __tls_get_addr. */ - -static GTY(()) rtx tls_get_addr_libfunc; - -static rtx -get_tls_get_addr (void) -{ - if (!tls_get_addr_libfunc) - tls_get_addr_libfunc = init_one_libfunc ("__tls_get_addr"); - return tls_get_addr_libfunc; -} - -/* Try machine-dependent ways of modifying an illegitimate address - to be legitimate. If we find one, return the new, valid address. */ - -rtx -alpha_legitimize_address (rtx x, rtx scratch, - enum machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED) -{ - HOST_WIDE_INT addend; - - /* If the address is (plus reg const_int) and the CONST_INT is not a - valid offset, compute the high part of the constant and add it to - the register. Then our address is (plus temp low-part-const). */ - if (GET_CODE (x) == PLUS - && GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == REG - && GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 1)) == CONST_INT - && ! CONSTANT_ADDRESS_P (XEXP (x, 1))) - { - addend = INTVAL (XEXP (x, 1)); - x = XEXP (x, 0); - goto split_addend; - } - - /* If the address is (const (plus FOO const_int)), find the low-order - part of the CONST_INT. Then load FOO plus any high-order part of the - CONST_INT into a register. Our address is (plus reg low-part-const). - This is done to reduce the number of GOT entries. */ - if (!no_new_pseudos - && GET_CODE (x) == CONST - && GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == PLUS - && GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 1)) == CONST_INT) - { - addend = INTVAL (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 1)); - x = force_reg (Pmode, XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 0)); - goto split_addend; - } - - /* If we have a (plus reg const), emit the load as in (2), then add - the two registers, and finally generate (plus reg low-part-const) as - our address. */ - if (!no_new_pseudos - && GET_CODE (x) == PLUS - && GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == REG - && GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 1)) == CONST - && GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (x, 1), 0)) == PLUS - && GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (x, 1), 0), 1)) == CONST_INT) - { - addend = INTVAL (XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (x, 1), 0), 1)); - x = expand_simple_binop (Pmode, PLUS, XEXP (x, 0), - XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (x, 1), 0), 0), - NULL_RTX, 1, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN); - goto split_addend; - } - - /* If this is a local symbol, split the address into HIGH/LO_SUM parts. */ - if (TARGET_EXPLICIT_RELOCS && symbolic_operand (x, Pmode)) - { - rtx r0, r16, eqv, tga, tp, insn, dest, seq; - - switch (tls_symbolic_operand_type (x)) - { - case TLS_MODEL_GLOBAL_DYNAMIC: - start_sequence (); - - r0 = gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, 0); - r16 = gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, 16); - tga = get_tls_get_addr (); - dest = gen_reg_rtx (Pmode); - seq = GEN_INT (alpha_next_sequence_number++); - - emit_insn (gen_movdi_er_tlsgd (r16, pic_offset_table_rtx, x, seq)); - insn = gen_call_value_osf_tlsgd (r0, tga, seq); - insn = emit_call_insn (insn); - CONST_OR_PURE_CALL_P (insn) = 1; - use_reg (&CALL_INSN_FUNCTION_USAGE (insn), r16); - - insn = get_insns (); - end_sequence (); - - emit_libcall_block (insn, dest, r0, x); - return dest; - - case TLS_MODEL_LOCAL_DYNAMIC: - start_sequence (); - - r0 = gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, 0); - r16 = gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, 16); - tga = get_tls_get_addr (); - scratch = gen_reg_rtx (Pmode); - seq = GEN_INT (alpha_next_sequence_number++); - - emit_insn (gen_movdi_er_tlsldm (r16, pic_offset_table_rtx, seq)); - insn = gen_call_value_osf_tlsldm (r0, tga, seq); - insn = emit_call_insn (insn); - CONST_OR_PURE_CALL_P (insn) = 1; - use_reg (&CALL_INSN_FUNCTION_USAGE (insn), r16); - - insn = get_insns (); - end_sequence (); - - eqv = gen_rtx_UNSPEC (Pmode, gen_rtvec (1, const0_rtx), - UNSPEC_TLSLDM_CALL); - emit_libcall_block (insn, scratch, r0, eqv); - - eqv = gen_rtx_UNSPEC (Pmode, gen_rtvec (1, x), UNSPEC_DTPREL); - eqv = gen_rtx_CONST (Pmode, eqv); - - if (alpha_tls_size == 64) - { - dest = gen_reg_rtx (Pmode); - emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, dest, eqv)); - emit_insn (gen_adddi3 (dest, dest, scratch)); - return dest; - } - if (alpha_tls_size == 32) - { - insn = gen_rtx_HIGH (Pmode, eqv); - insn = gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, scratch, insn); - scratch = gen_reg_rtx (Pmode); - emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, scratch, insn)); - } - return gen_rtx_LO_SUM (Pmode, scratch, eqv); - - case TLS_MODEL_INITIAL_EXEC: - eqv = gen_rtx_UNSPEC (Pmode, gen_rtvec (1, x), UNSPEC_TPREL); - eqv = gen_rtx_CONST (Pmode, eqv); - tp = gen_reg_rtx (Pmode); - scratch = gen_reg_rtx (Pmode); - dest = gen_reg_rtx (Pmode); - - emit_insn (gen_load_tp (tp)); - emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, scratch, eqv)); - emit_insn (gen_adddi3 (dest, tp, scratch)); - return dest; - - case TLS_MODEL_LOCAL_EXEC: - eqv = gen_rtx_UNSPEC (Pmode, gen_rtvec (1, x), UNSPEC_TPREL); - eqv = gen_rtx_CONST (Pmode, eqv); - tp = gen_reg_rtx (Pmode); - - emit_insn (gen_load_tp (tp)); - if (alpha_tls_size == 32) - { - insn = gen_rtx_HIGH (Pmode, eqv); - insn = gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, tp, insn); - tp = gen_reg_rtx (Pmode); - emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, tp, insn)); - } - return gen_rtx_LO_SUM (Pmode, tp, eqv); - } - - if (local_symbolic_operand (x, Pmode)) - { - if (small_symbolic_operand (x, Pmode)) - return x; - else - { - if (!no_new_pseudos) - scratch = gen_reg_rtx (Pmode); - emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, scratch, - gen_rtx_HIGH (Pmode, x))); - return gen_rtx_LO_SUM (Pmode, scratch, x); - } - } - } - - return NULL; - - split_addend: - { - HOST_WIDE_INT low, high; - - low = ((addend & 0xffff) ^ 0x8000) - 0x8000; - addend -= low; - high = ((addend & 0xffffffff) ^ 0x80000000) - 0x80000000; - addend -= high; - - if (addend) - x = expand_simple_binop (Pmode, PLUS, x, GEN_INT (addend), - (no_new_pseudos ? scratch : NULL_RTX), - 1, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN); - if (high) - x = expand_simple_binop (Pmode, PLUS, x, GEN_INT (high), - (no_new_pseudos ? scratch : NULL_RTX), - 1, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN); - - return plus_constant (x, low); - } -} - -/* Primarily this is required for TLS symbols, but given that our move - patterns *ought* to be able to handle any symbol at any time, we - should never be spilling symbolic operands to the constant pool, ever. */ - -static bool -alpha_cannot_force_const_mem (rtx x) -{ - enum rtx_code code = GET_CODE (x); - return code == SYMBOL_REF || code == LABEL_REF || code == CONST; -} - -/* We do not allow indirect calls to be optimized into sibling calls, nor - can we allow a call to a function with a different GP to be optimized - into a sibcall. */ - -static bool -alpha_function_ok_for_sibcall (tree decl, tree exp ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED) -{ - /* Can't do indirect tail calls, since we don't know if the target - uses the same GP. */ - if (!decl) - return false; - - /* Otherwise, we can make a tail call if the target function shares - the same GP. */ - return decl_has_samegp (decl); -} - -/* For TARGET_EXPLICIT_RELOCS, we don't obfuscate a SYMBOL_REF to a - small symbolic operand until after reload. At which point we need - to replace (mem (symbol_ref)) with (mem (lo_sum $29 symbol_ref)) - so that sched2 has the proper dependency information. */ - -static int -some_small_symbolic_operand_1 (rtx *px, void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED) -{ - rtx x = *px; - - /* Don't re-split. */ - if (GET_CODE (x) == LO_SUM) - return -1; - - return small_symbolic_operand (x, Pmode) != 0; -} - -int -some_small_symbolic_operand (rtx x, enum machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED) -{ - return for_each_rtx (&x, some_small_symbolic_operand_1, NULL); -} - -static int -split_small_symbolic_operand_1 (rtx *px, void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED) -{ - rtx x = *px; - - /* Don't re-split. */ - if (GET_CODE (x) == LO_SUM) - return -1; - - if (small_symbolic_operand (x, Pmode)) - { - x = gen_rtx_LO_SUM (Pmode, pic_offset_table_rtx, x); - *px = x; - return -1; - } - - return 0; -} - -rtx -split_small_symbolic_operand (rtx x) -{ - x = copy_insn (x); - for_each_rtx (&x, split_small_symbolic_operand_1, NULL); - return x; -} - -/* Indicate that INSN cannot be duplicated. This is true for any insn - that we've marked with gpdisp relocs, since those have to stay in - 1-1 correspondence with one another. - - Technically we could copy them if we could set up a mapping from one - sequence number to another, across the set of insns to be duplicated. - This seems overly complicated and error-prone since interblock motion - from sched-ebb could move one of the pair of insns to a different block. - - Also cannot allow jsr insns to be duplicated. If they throw exceptions, - then they'll be in a different block from their ldgp. Which could lead - the bb reorder code to think that it would be ok to copy just the block - containing the call and branch to the block containing the ldgp. */ - -static bool -alpha_cannot_copy_insn_p (rtx insn) -{ - if (!reload_completed || !TARGET_EXPLICIT_RELOCS) - return false; - if (recog_memoized (insn) >= 0) - return get_attr_cannot_copy (insn); - else - return false; -} - - -/* Try a machine-dependent way of reloading an illegitimate address - operand. If we find one, push the reload and return the new rtx. */ - -rtx -alpha_legitimize_reload_address (rtx x, - enum machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, - int opnum, int type, - int ind_levels ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED) -{ - /* We must recognize output that we have already generated ourselves. */ - if (GET_CODE (x) == PLUS - && GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == PLUS - && GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 0)) == REG - && GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 1)) == CONST_INT - && GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 1)) == CONST_INT) - { - push_reload (XEXP (x, 0), NULL_RTX, &XEXP (x, 0), NULL, - BASE_REG_CLASS, GET_MODE (x), VOIDmode, 0, 0, - opnum, type); - return x; - } - - /* We wish to handle large displacements off a base register by - splitting the addend across an ldah and the mem insn. This - cuts number of extra insns needed from 3 to 1. */ - if (GET_CODE (x) == PLUS - && GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == REG - && REGNO (XEXP (x, 0)) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER - && REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P (REGNO (XEXP (x, 0))) - && GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 1)) == CONST_INT) - { - HOST_WIDE_INT val = INTVAL (XEXP (x, 1)); - HOST_WIDE_INT low = ((val & 0xffff) ^ 0x8000) - 0x8000; - HOST_WIDE_INT high - = (((val - low) & 0xffffffff) ^ 0x80000000) - 0x80000000; - - /* Check for 32-bit overflow. */ - if (high + low != val) - return NULL_RTX; - - /* Reload the high part into a base reg; leave the low part - in the mem directly. */ - x = gen_rtx_PLUS (GET_MODE (x), - gen_rtx_PLUS (GET_MODE (x), XEXP (x, 0), - GEN_INT (high)), - GEN_INT (low)); - - push_reload (XEXP (x, 0), NULL_RTX, &XEXP (x, 0), NULL, - BASE_REG_CLASS, GET_MODE (x), VOIDmode, 0, 0, - opnum, type); - return x; - } - - return NULL_RTX; -} - -/* Compute a (partial) cost for rtx X. Return true if the complete - cost has been computed, and false if subexpressions should be - scanned. In either case, *TOTAL contains the cost result. */ - -static bool -alpha_rtx_costs (rtx x, int code, int outer_code, int *total) -{ - enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (x); - bool float_mode_p = FLOAT_MODE_P (mode); - - switch (code) - { - /* If this is an 8-bit constant, return zero since it can be used - nearly anywhere with no cost. If it is a valid operand for an - ADD or AND, likewise return 0 if we know it will be used in that - context. Otherwise, return 2 since it might be used there later. - All other constants take at least two insns. */ - case CONST_INT: - if (INTVAL (x) >= 0 && INTVAL (x) < 256) - { - *total = 0; - return true; - } - /* FALLTHRU */ - - case CONST_DOUBLE: - if (x == CONST0_RTX (mode)) - *total = 0; - else if ((outer_code == PLUS && add_operand (x, VOIDmode)) - || (outer_code == AND && and_operand (x, VOIDmode))) - *total = 0; - else if (add_operand (x, VOIDmode) || and_operand (x, VOIDmode)) - *total = 2; - else - *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (2); - return true; - - case CONST: - case SYMBOL_REF: - case LABEL_REF: - if (TARGET_EXPLICIT_RELOCS && small_symbolic_operand (x, VOIDmode)) - *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (outer_code != MEM); - else if (TARGET_EXPLICIT_RELOCS && local_symbolic_operand (x, VOIDmode)) - *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (1 + (outer_code != MEM)); - else if (tls_symbolic_operand_type (x)) - /* Estimate of cost for call_pal rduniq. */ - *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (15); - else - /* Otherwise we do a load from the GOT. */ - *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (alpha_memory_latency); - return true; - - case PLUS: - case MINUS: - if (float_mode_p) - *total = alpha_rtx_cost_data[alpha_cpu].fp_add; - else if (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == MULT - && const48_operand (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 1), VOIDmode)) - { - *total = (rtx_cost (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 0), outer_code) - + rtx_cost (XEXP (x, 1), outer_code) + 2); - return true; - } - return false; - - case MULT: - if (float_mode_p) - *total = alpha_rtx_cost_data[alpha_cpu].fp_mult; - else if (mode == DImode) - *total = alpha_rtx_cost_data[alpha_cpu].int_mult_di; - else - *total = alpha_rtx_cost_data[alpha_cpu].int_mult_si; - return false; - - case ASHIFT: - if (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 1)) == CONST_INT - && INTVAL (XEXP (x, 1)) <= 3) - { - *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (1); - return false; - } - /* FALLTHRU */ - - case ASHIFTRT: - case LSHIFTRT: - *total = alpha_rtx_cost_data[alpha_cpu].int_shift; - return false; - - case IF_THEN_ELSE: - if (float_mode_p) - *total = alpha_rtx_cost_data[alpha_cpu].fp_add; - else - *total = alpha_rtx_cost_data[alpha_cpu].int_cmov; - return false; - - case DIV: - case UDIV: - case MOD: - case UMOD: - if (!float_mode_p) - *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (70); /* ??? */ - else if (mode == SFmode) - *total = alpha_rtx_cost_data[alpha_cpu].fp_div_sf; - else - *total = alpha_rtx_cost_data[alpha_cpu].fp_div_df; - return false; - - case MEM: - *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (alpha_memory_latency); - return true; - - case NEG: - if (! float_mode_p) - { - *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (1); - return false; - } - /* FALLTHRU */ - - case ABS: - if (! float_mode_p) - { - *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (1) + alpha_rtx_cost_data[alpha_cpu].int_cmov; - return false; - } - /* FALLTHRU */ - - case FLOAT: - case UNSIGNED_FLOAT: - case FIX: - case UNSIGNED_FIX: - case FLOAT_EXTEND: - case FLOAT_TRUNCATE: - *total = alpha_rtx_cost_data[alpha_cpu].fp_add; - return false; - - default: - return false; - } -} - -/* REF is an alignable memory location. Place an aligned SImode - reference into *PALIGNED_MEM and the number of bits to shift into - *PBITNUM. SCRATCH is a free register for use in reloading out - of range stack slots. */ - -void -get_aligned_mem (rtx ref, rtx *paligned_mem, rtx *pbitnum) -{ - rtx base; - HOST_WIDE_INT offset = 0; - - if (GET_CODE (ref) != MEM) - abort (); - - if (reload_in_progress - && ! memory_address_p (GET_MODE (ref), XEXP (ref, 0))) - { - base = find_replacement (&XEXP (ref, 0)); - - if (! memory_address_p (GET_MODE (ref), base)) - abort (); - } - else - { - base = XEXP (ref, 0); - } - - if (GET_CODE (base) == PLUS) - offset += INTVAL (XEXP (base, 1)), base = XEXP (base, 0); - - *paligned_mem - = widen_memory_access (ref, SImode, (offset & ~3) - offset); - - if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN) - *pbitnum = GEN_INT (32 - (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (ref)) - + (offset & 3) * 8)); - else - *pbitnum = GEN_INT ((offset & 3) * 8); -} - -/* Similar, but just get the address. Handle the two reload cases. - Add EXTRA_OFFSET to the address we return. */ - -rtx -get_unaligned_address (rtx ref, int extra_offset) -{ - rtx base; - HOST_WIDE_INT offset = 0; - - if (GET_CODE (ref) != MEM) - abort (); - - if (reload_in_progress - && ! memory_address_p (GET_MODE (ref), XEXP (ref, 0))) - { - base = find_replacement (&XEXP (ref, 0)); - - if (! memory_address_p (GET_MODE (ref), base)) - abort (); - } - else - { - base = XEXP (ref, 0); - } - - if (GET_CODE (base) == PLUS) - offset += INTVAL (XEXP (base, 1)), base = XEXP (base, 0); - - return plus_constant (base, offset + extra_offset); -} - -/* On the Alpha, all (non-symbolic) constants except zero go into - a floating-point register via memory. Note that we cannot - return anything that is not a subset of CLASS, and that some - symbolic constants cannot be dropped to memory. */ - -enum reg_class -alpha_preferred_reload_class(rtx x, enum reg_class class) -{ - /* Zero is present in any register class. */ - if (x == CONST0_RTX (GET_MODE (x))) - return class; - - /* These sorts of constants we can easily drop to memory. */ - if (GET_CODE (x) == CONST_INT || GET_CODE (x) == CONST_DOUBLE) - { - if (class == FLOAT_REGS) - return NO_REGS; - if (class == ALL_REGS) - return GENERAL_REGS; - return class; - } - - /* All other kinds of constants should not (and in the case of HIGH - cannot) be dropped to memory -- instead we use a GENERAL_REGS - secondary reload. */ - if (CONSTANT_P (x)) - return (class == ALL_REGS ? GENERAL_REGS : class); - - return class; -} - -/* Loading and storing HImode or QImode values to and from memory - usually requires a scratch register. The exceptions are loading - QImode and HImode from an aligned address to a general register - unless byte instructions are permitted. - - We also cannot load an unaligned address or a paradoxical SUBREG - into an FP register. - - We also cannot do integral arithmetic into FP regs, as might result - from register elimination into a DImode fp register. */ - -enum reg_class -secondary_reload_class (enum reg_class class, enum machine_mode mode, - rtx x, int in) -{ - if ((mode == QImode || mode == HImode) && ! TARGET_BWX) - { - if (GET_CODE (x) == MEM - || (GET_CODE (x) == REG && REGNO (x) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER) - || (GET_CODE (x) == SUBREG - && (GET_CODE (SUBREG_REG (x)) == MEM - || (GET_CODE (SUBREG_REG (x)) == REG - && REGNO (SUBREG_REG (x)) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)))) - { - if (!in || !aligned_memory_operand(x, mode)) - return GENERAL_REGS; - } - } - - if (class == FLOAT_REGS) - { - if (GET_CODE (x) == MEM && GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == AND) - return GENERAL_REGS; - - if (GET_CODE (x) == SUBREG - && (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x)) - > GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (x))))) - return GENERAL_REGS; - - if (in && INTEGRAL_MODE_P (mode) - && ! (memory_operand (x, mode) || x == const0_rtx)) - return GENERAL_REGS; - } - - return NO_REGS; -} - -/* Subfunction of the following function. Update the flags of any MEM - found in part of X. */ - -static void -alpha_set_memflags_1 (rtx x, int in_struct_p, int volatile_p, int unchanging_p) -{ - int i; - - switch (GET_CODE (x)) - { - case SEQUENCE: - abort (); - - case PARALLEL: - for (i = XVECLEN (x, 0) - 1; i >= 0; i--) - alpha_set_memflags_1 (XVECEXP (x, 0, i), in_struct_p, volatile_p, - unchanging_p); - break; - - case INSN: - alpha_set_memflags_1 (PATTERN (x), in_struct_p, volatile_p, - unchanging_p); - break; - - case SET: - alpha_set_memflags_1 (SET_DEST (x), in_struct_p, volatile_p, - unchanging_p); - alpha_set_memflags_1 (SET_SRC (x), in_struct_p, volatile_p, - unchanging_p); - break; - - case MEM: - MEM_IN_STRUCT_P (x) = in_struct_p; - MEM_VOLATILE_P (x) = volatile_p; - RTX_UNCHANGING_P (x) = unchanging_p; - /* Sadly, we cannot use alias sets because the extra aliasing - produced by the AND interferes. Given that two-byte quantities - are the only thing we would be able to differentiate anyway, - there does not seem to be any point in convoluting the early - out of the alias check. */ - break; - - default: - break; - } -} - -/* Given INSN, which is an INSN list or the PATTERN of a single insn - generated to perform a memory operation, look for any MEMs in either - a SET_DEST or a SET_SRC and copy the in-struct, unchanging, and - volatile flags from REF into each of the MEMs found. If REF is not - a MEM, don't do anything. */ - -void -alpha_set_memflags (rtx insn, rtx ref) -{ - int in_struct_p, volatile_p, unchanging_p; - - if (GET_CODE (ref) != MEM) - return; - - in_struct_p = MEM_IN_STRUCT_P (ref); - volatile_p = MEM_VOLATILE_P (ref); - unchanging_p = RTX_UNCHANGING_P (ref); - - /* This is only called from alpha.md, after having had something - generated from one of the insn patterns. So if everything is - zero, the pattern is already up-to-date. */ - if (! in_struct_p && ! volatile_p && ! unchanging_p) - return; - - alpha_set_memflags_1 (insn, in_struct_p, volatile_p, unchanging_p); -} - -/* Internal routine for alpha_emit_set_const to check for N or below insns. */ - -static rtx -alpha_emit_set_const_1 (rtx target, enum machine_mode mode, - HOST_WIDE_INT c, int n) -{ - HOST_WIDE_INT new; - int i, bits; - /* Use a pseudo if highly optimizing and still generating RTL. */ - rtx subtarget - = (flag_expensive_optimizations && !no_new_pseudos ? 0 : target); - rtx temp, insn; - - /* If this is a sign-extended 32-bit constant, we can do this in at most - three insns, so do it if we have enough insns left. We always have - a sign-extended 32-bit constant when compiling on a narrow machine. */ - - if (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT != 64 - || c >> 31 == -1 || c >> 31 == 0) - { - HOST_WIDE_INT low = ((c & 0xffff) ^ 0x8000) - 0x8000; - HOST_WIDE_INT tmp1 = c - low; - HOST_WIDE_INT high = (((tmp1 >> 16) & 0xffff) ^ 0x8000) - 0x8000; - HOST_WIDE_INT extra = 0; - - /* If HIGH will be interpreted as negative but the constant is - positive, we must adjust it to do two ldha insns. */ - - if ((high & 0x8000) != 0 && c >= 0) - { - extra = 0x4000; - tmp1 -= 0x40000000; - high = ((tmp1 >> 16) & 0xffff) - 2 * ((tmp1 >> 16) & 0x8000); - } - - if (c == low || (low == 0 && extra == 0)) - { - /* We used to use copy_to_suggested_reg (GEN_INT (c), target, mode) - but that meant that we can't handle INT_MIN on 32-bit machines - (like NT/Alpha), because we recurse indefinitely through - emit_move_insn to gen_movdi. So instead, since we know exactly - what we want, create it explicitly. */ - - if (target == NULL) - target = gen_reg_rtx (mode); - emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, target, GEN_INT (c))); - return target; - } - else if (n >= 2 + (extra != 0)) - { - if (no_new_pseudos) - { - emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, target, GEN_INT (high << 16))); - temp = target; - } - else - temp = copy_to_suggested_reg (GEN_INT (high << 16), - subtarget, mode); - - /* As of 2002-02-23, addsi3 is only available when not optimizing. - This means that if we go through expand_binop, we'll try to - generate extensions, etc, which will require new pseudos, which - will fail during some split phases. The SImode add patterns - still exist, but are not named. So build the insns by hand. */ - - if (extra != 0) - { - if (! subtarget) - subtarget = gen_reg_rtx (mode); - insn = gen_rtx_PLUS (mode, temp, GEN_INT (extra << 16)); - insn = gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, subtarget, insn); - emit_insn (insn); - temp = subtarget; - } - - if (target == NULL) - target = gen_reg_rtx (mode); - insn = gen_rtx_PLUS (mode, temp, GEN_INT (low)); - insn = gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, target, insn); - emit_insn (insn); - return target; - } - } - - /* If we couldn't do it that way, try some other methods. But if we have - no instructions left, don't bother. Likewise, if this is SImode and - we can't make pseudos, we can't do anything since the expand_binop - and expand_unop calls will widen and try to make pseudos. */ - - if (n == 1 || (mode == SImode && no_new_pseudos)) - return 0; - - /* Next, see if we can load a related constant and then shift and possibly - negate it to get the constant we want. Try this once each increasing - numbers of insns. */ - - for (i = 1; i < n; i++) - { - /* First, see if minus some low bits, we've an easy load of - high bits. */ - - new = ((c & 0xffff) ^ 0x8000) - 0x8000; - if (new != 0 - && (temp = alpha_emit_set_const (subtarget, mode, c - new, i)) != 0) - return expand_binop (mode, add_optab, temp, GEN_INT (new), - target, 0, OPTAB_WIDEN); - - /* Next try complementing. */ - if ((temp = alpha_emit_set_const (subtarget, mode, ~ c, i)) != 0) - return expand_unop (mode, one_cmpl_optab, temp, target, 0); - - /* Next try to form a constant and do a left shift. We can do this - if some low-order bits are zero; the exact_log2 call below tells - us that information. The bits we are shifting out could be any - value, but here we'll just try the 0- and sign-extended forms of - the constant. To try to increase the chance of having the same - constant in more than one insn, start at the highest number of - bits to shift, but try all possibilities in case a ZAPNOT will - be useful. */ - - if ((bits = exact_log2 (c & - c)) > 0) - for (; bits > 0; bits--) - if ((temp = (alpha_emit_set_const - (subtarget, mode, c >> bits, i))) != 0 - || ((temp = (alpha_emit_set_const - (subtarget, mode, - ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) c) >> bits, i))) - != 0)) - return expand_binop (mode, ashl_optab, temp, GEN_INT (bits), - target, 0, OPTAB_WIDEN); - - /* Now try high-order zero bits. Here we try the shifted-in bits as - all zero and all ones. Be careful to avoid shifting outside the - mode and to avoid shifting outside the host wide int size. */ - /* On narrow hosts, don't shift a 1 into the high bit, since we'll - confuse the recursive call and set all of the high 32 bits. */ - - if ((bits = (MIN (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT, GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) * 8) - - floor_log2 (c) - 1 - (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT < 64))) > 0) - for (; bits > 0; bits--) - if ((temp = alpha_emit_set_const (subtarget, mode, - c << bits, i)) != 0 - || ((temp = (alpha_emit_set_const - (subtarget, mode, - ((c << bits) | (((HOST_WIDE_INT) 1 << bits) - 1)), - i))) - != 0)) - return expand_binop (mode, lshr_optab, temp, GEN_INT (bits), - target, 1, OPTAB_WIDEN); - - /* Now try high-order 1 bits. We get that with a sign-extension. - But one bit isn't enough here. Be careful to avoid shifting outside - the mode and to avoid shifting outside the host wide int size. */ - - if ((bits = (MIN (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT, GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) * 8) - - floor_log2 (~ c) - 2)) > 0) - for (; bits > 0; bits--) - if ((temp = alpha_emit_set_const (subtarget, mode, - c << bits, i)) != 0 - || ((temp = (alpha_emit_set_const - (subtarget, mode, - ((c << bits) | (((HOST_WIDE_INT) 1 << bits) - 1)), - i))) - != 0)) - return expand_binop (mode, ashr_optab, temp, GEN_INT (bits), - target, 0, OPTAB_WIDEN); - } - -#if HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 64 - /* Finally, see if can load a value into the target that is the same as the - constant except that all bytes that are 0 are changed to be 0xff. If we - can, then we can do a ZAPNOT to obtain the desired constant. */ - - new = c; - for (i = 0; i < 64; i += 8) - if ((new & ((HOST_WIDE_INT) 0xff << i)) == 0) - new |= (HOST_WIDE_INT) 0xff << i; - - /* We are only called for SImode and DImode. If this is SImode, ensure that - we are sign extended to a full word. */ - - if (mode == SImode) - new = ((new & 0xffffffff) ^ 0x80000000) - 0x80000000; - - if (new != c && new != -1 - && (temp = alpha_emit_set_const (subtarget, mode, new, n - 1)) != 0) - return expand_binop (mode, and_optab, temp, GEN_INT (c | ~ new), - target, 0, OPTAB_WIDEN); -#endif - - return 0; -} - -/* Try to output insns to set TARGET equal to the constant C if it can be - done in less than N insns. Do all computations in MODE. Returns the place - where the output has been placed if it can be done and the insns have been - emitted. If it would take more than N insns, zero is returned and no - insns and emitted. */ - -rtx -alpha_emit_set_const (rtx target, enum machine_mode mode, - HOST_WIDE_INT c, int n) -{ - rtx result = 0; - rtx orig_target = target; - int i; - - /* If we can't make any pseudos, TARGET is an SImode hard register, we - can't load this constant in one insn, do this in DImode. */ - if (no_new_pseudos && mode == SImode - && GET_CODE (target) == REG && REGNO (target) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER - && (result = alpha_emit_set_const_1 (target, mode, c, 1)) == 0) - { - target = gen_lowpart (DImode, target); - mode = DImode; - } - - /* Try 1 insn, then 2, then up to N. */ - for (i = 1; i <= n; i++) - { - result = alpha_emit_set_const_1 (target, mode, c, i); - if (result) - { - rtx insn = get_last_insn (); - rtx set = single_set (insn); - if (! CONSTANT_P (SET_SRC (set))) - set_unique_reg_note (get_last_insn (), REG_EQUAL, GEN_INT (c)); - break; - } - } - - /* Allow for the case where we changed the mode of TARGET. */ - if (result == target) - result = orig_target; - - return result; -} - -/* Having failed to find a 3 insn sequence in alpha_emit_set_const, - fall back to a straight forward decomposition. We do this to avoid - exponential run times encountered when looking for longer sequences - with alpha_emit_set_const. */ - -rtx -alpha_emit_set_long_const (rtx target, HOST_WIDE_INT c1, HOST_WIDE_INT c2) -{ - HOST_WIDE_INT d1, d2, d3, d4; - - /* Decompose the entire word */ -#if HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT >= 64 - if (c2 != -(c1 < 0)) - abort (); - d1 = ((c1 & 0xffff) ^ 0x8000) - 0x8000; - c1 -= d1; - d2 = ((c1 & 0xffffffff) ^ 0x80000000) - 0x80000000; - c1 = (c1 - d2) >> 32; - d3 = ((c1 & 0xffff) ^ 0x8000) - 0x8000; - c1 -= d3; - d4 = ((c1 & 0xffffffff) ^ 0x80000000) - 0x80000000; - if (c1 != d4) - abort (); -#else - d1 = ((c1 & 0xffff) ^ 0x8000) - 0x8000; - c1 -= d1; - d2 = ((c1 & 0xffffffff) ^ 0x80000000) - 0x80000000; - if (c1 != d2) - abort (); - c2 += (d2 < 0); - d3 = ((c2 & 0xffff) ^ 0x8000) - 0x8000; - c2 -= d3; - d4 = ((c2 & 0xffffffff) ^ 0x80000000) - 0x80000000; - if (c2 != d4) - abort (); -#endif - - /* Construct the high word */ - if (d4) - { - emit_move_insn (target, GEN_INT (d4)); - if (d3) - emit_move_insn (target, gen_rtx_PLUS (DImode, target, GEN_INT (d3))); - } - else - emit_move_insn (target, GEN_INT (d3)); - - /* Shift it into place */ - emit_move_insn (target, gen_rtx_ASHIFT (DImode, target, GEN_INT (32))); - - /* Add in the low bits. */ - if (d2) - emit_move_insn (target, gen_rtx_PLUS (DImode, target, GEN_INT (d2))); - if (d1) - emit_move_insn (target, gen_rtx_PLUS (DImode, target, GEN_INT (d1))); - - return target; -} - -/* Expand a move instruction; return true if all work is done. - We don't handle non-bwx subword loads here. */ - -bool -alpha_expand_mov (enum machine_mode mode, rtx *operands) -{ - /* If the output is not a register, the input must be. */ - if (GET_CODE (operands[0]) == MEM - && ! reg_or_0_operand (operands[1], mode)) - operands[1] = force_reg (mode, operands[1]); - - /* Allow legitimize_address to perform some simplifications. */ - if (mode == Pmode && symbolic_operand (operands[1], mode)) - { - rtx tmp; - - /* With RTL inlining, at -O3, rtl is generated, stored, then actually - compiled at the end of compilation. In the meantime, someone can - re-encode-section-info on some symbol changing it e.g. from global - to local-not-small. If this happens, we'd have emitted a plain - load rather than a high+losum load and not recognize the insn. - - So if rtl inlining is in effect, we delay the global/not-global - decision until rest_of_compilation by wrapping it in an - UNSPEC_SYMBOL. */ - if (TARGET_EXPLICIT_RELOCS && flag_inline_functions - && rtx_equal_function_value_matters - && global_symbolic_operand (operands[1], mode)) - { - emit_insn (gen_movdi_er_maybe_g (operands[0], operands[1])); - return true; - } - - tmp = alpha_legitimize_address (operands[1], operands[0], mode); - if (tmp) - { - if (tmp == operands[0]) - return true; - operands[1] = tmp; - return false; - } - } - - /* Early out for non-constants and valid constants. */ - if (! CONSTANT_P (operands[1]) || input_operand (operands[1], mode)) - return false; - - /* Split large integers. */ - if (GET_CODE (operands[1]) == CONST_INT - || GET_CODE (operands[1]) == CONST_DOUBLE) - { - HOST_WIDE_INT i0, i1; - rtx temp = NULL_RTX; - - if (GET_CODE (operands[1]) == CONST_INT) - { - i0 = INTVAL (operands[1]); - i1 = -(i0 < 0); - } - else if (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT >= 64) - { - i0 = CONST_DOUBLE_LOW (operands[1]); - i1 = -(i0 < 0); - } - else - { - i0 = CONST_DOUBLE_LOW (operands[1]); - i1 = CONST_DOUBLE_HIGH (operands[1]); - } - - if (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT >= 64 || i1 == -(i0 < 0)) - temp = alpha_emit_set_const (operands[0], mode, i0, 3); - - if (!temp && TARGET_BUILD_CONSTANTS) - temp = alpha_emit_set_long_const (operands[0], i0, i1); - - if (temp) - { - if (rtx_equal_p (operands[0], temp)) - return true; - operands[1] = temp; - return false; - } - } - - /* Otherwise we've nothing left but to drop the thing to memory. */ - operands[1] = force_const_mem (mode, operands[1]); - if (reload_in_progress) - { - emit_move_insn (operands[0], XEXP (operands[1], 0)); - operands[1] = copy_rtx (operands[1]); - XEXP (operands[1], 0) = operands[0]; - } - else - operands[1] = validize_mem (operands[1]); - return false; -} - -/* Expand a non-bwx QImode or HImode move instruction; - return true if all work is done. */ - -bool -alpha_expand_mov_nobwx (enum machine_mode mode, rtx *operands) -{ - /* If the output is not a register, the input must be. */ - if (GET_CODE (operands[0]) == MEM) - operands[1] = force_reg (mode, operands[1]); - - /* Handle four memory cases, unaligned and aligned for either the input - or the output. The only case where we can be called during reload is - for aligned loads; all other cases require temporaries. */ - - if (GET_CODE (operands[1]) == MEM - || (GET_CODE (operands[1]) == SUBREG - && GET_CODE (SUBREG_REG (operands[1])) == MEM) - || (reload_in_progress && GET_CODE (operands[1]) == REG - && REGNO (operands[1]) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER) - || (reload_in_progress && GET_CODE (operands[1]) == SUBREG - && GET_CODE (SUBREG_REG (operands[1])) == REG - && REGNO (SUBREG_REG (operands[1])) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)) - { - if (aligned_memory_operand (operands[1], mode)) - { - if (reload_in_progress) - { - emit_insn ((mode == QImode - ? gen_reload_inqi_help - : gen_reload_inhi_help) - (operands[0], operands[1], - gen_rtx_REG (SImode, REGNO (operands[0])))); - } - else - { - rtx aligned_mem, bitnum; - rtx scratch = gen_reg_rtx (SImode); - rtx subtarget; - bool copyout; - - get_aligned_mem (operands[1], &aligned_mem, &bitnum); - - subtarget = operands[0]; - if (GET_CODE (subtarget) == REG) - subtarget = gen_lowpart (DImode, subtarget), copyout = false; - else - subtarget = gen_reg_rtx (DImode), copyout = true; - - emit_insn ((mode == QImode - ? gen_aligned_loadqi - : gen_aligned_loadhi) - (subtarget, aligned_mem, bitnum, scratch)); - - if (copyout) - emit_move_insn (operands[0], gen_lowpart (mode, subtarget)); - } - } - else - { - /* Don't pass these as parameters since that makes the generated - code depend on parameter evaluation order which will cause - bootstrap failures. */ - - rtx temp1, temp2, seq, subtarget; - bool copyout; - - temp1 = gen_reg_rtx (DImode); - temp2 = gen_reg_rtx (DImode); - - subtarget = operands[0]; - if (GET_CODE (subtarget) == REG) - subtarget = gen_lowpart (DImode, subtarget), copyout = false; - else - subtarget = gen_reg_rtx (DImode), copyout = true; - - seq = ((mode == QImode - ? gen_unaligned_loadqi - : gen_unaligned_loadhi) - (subtarget, get_unaligned_address (operands[1], 0), - temp1, temp2)); - alpha_set_memflags (seq, operands[1]); - emit_insn (seq); - - if (copyout) - emit_move_insn (operands[0], gen_lowpart (mode, subtarget)); - } - return true; - } - - if (GET_CODE (operands[0]) == MEM - || (GET_CODE (operands[0]) == SUBREG - && GET_CODE (SUBREG_REG (operands[0])) == MEM) - || (reload_in_progress && GET_CODE (operands[0]) == REG - && REGNO (operands[0]) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER) - || (reload_in_progress && GET_CODE (operands[0]) == SUBREG - && GET_CODE (SUBREG_REG (operands[0])) == REG - && REGNO (operands[0]) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)) - { - if (aligned_memory_operand (operands[0], mode)) - { - rtx aligned_mem, bitnum; - rtx temp1 = gen_reg_rtx (SImode); - rtx temp2 = gen_reg_rtx (SImode); - - get_aligned_mem (operands[0], &aligned_mem, &bitnum); - - emit_insn (gen_aligned_store (aligned_mem, operands[1], bitnum, - temp1, temp2)); - } - else - { - rtx temp1 = gen_reg_rtx (DImode); - rtx temp2 = gen_reg_rtx (DImode); - rtx temp3 = gen_reg_rtx (DImode); - rtx seq = ((mode == QImode - ? gen_unaligned_storeqi - : gen_unaligned_storehi) - (get_unaligned_address (operands[0], 0), - operands[1], temp1, temp2, temp3)); - - alpha_set_memflags (seq, operands[0]); - emit_insn (seq); - } - return true; - } - - return false; -} - -/* Generate an unsigned DImode to FP conversion. This is the same code - optabs would emit if we didn't have TFmode patterns. - - For SFmode, this is the only construction I've found that can pass - gcc.c-torture/execute/ieee/rbug.c. No scenario that uses DFmode - intermediates will work, because you'll get intermediate rounding - that ruins the end result. Some of this could be fixed by turning - on round-to-positive-infinity, but that requires diddling the fpsr, - which kills performance. I tried turning this around and converting - to a negative number, so that I could turn on /m, but either I did - it wrong or there's something else cause I wound up with the exact - same single-bit error. There is a branch-less form of this same code: - - srl $16,1,$1 - and $16,1,$2 - cmplt $16,0,$3 - or $1,$2,$2 - cmovge $16,$16,$2 - itoft $3,$f10 - itoft $2,$f11 - cvtqs $f11,$f11 - adds $f11,$f11,$f0 - fcmoveq $f10,$f11,$f0 - - I'm not using it because it's the same number of instructions as - this branch-full form, and it has more serialized long latency - instructions on the critical path. - - For DFmode, we can avoid rounding errors by breaking up the word - into two pieces, converting them separately, and adding them back: - - LC0: .long 0,0x5f800000 - - itoft $16,$f11 - lda $2,LC0 - cmplt $16,0,$1 - cpyse $f11,$f31,$f10 - cpyse $f31,$f11,$f11 - s4addq $1,$2,$1 - lds $f12,0($1) - cvtqt $f10,$f10 - cvtqt $f11,$f11 - addt $f12,$f10,$f0 - addt $f0,$f11,$f0 - - This doesn't seem to be a clear-cut win over the optabs form. - It probably all depends on the distribution of numbers being - converted -- in the optabs form, all but high-bit-set has a - much lower minimum execution time. */ - -void -alpha_emit_floatuns (rtx operands[2]) -{ - rtx neglab, donelab, i0, i1, f0, in, out; - enum machine_mode mode; - - out = operands[0]; - in = force_reg (DImode, operands[1]); - mode = GET_MODE (out); - neglab = gen_label_rtx (); - donelab = gen_label_rtx (); - i0 = gen_reg_rtx (DImode); - i1 = gen_reg_rtx (DImode); - f0 = gen_reg_rtx (mode); - - emit_cmp_and_jump_insns (in, const0_rtx, LT, const0_rtx, DImode, 0, neglab); - - emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, out, gen_rtx_FLOAT (mode, in))); - emit_jump_insn (gen_jump (donelab)); - emit_barrier (); - - emit_label (neglab); - - emit_insn (gen_lshrdi3 (i0, in, const1_rtx)); - emit_insn (gen_anddi3 (i1, in, const1_rtx)); - emit_insn (gen_iordi3 (i0, i0, i1)); - emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, f0, gen_rtx_FLOAT (mode, i0))); - emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, out, gen_rtx_PLUS (mode, f0, f0))); - - emit_label (donelab); -} - -/* Generate the comparison for a conditional branch. */ - -rtx -alpha_emit_conditional_branch (enum rtx_code code) -{ - enum rtx_code cmp_code, branch_code; - enum machine_mode cmp_mode, branch_mode = VOIDmode; - rtx op0 = alpha_compare.op0, op1 = alpha_compare.op1; - rtx tem; - - if (alpha_compare.fp_p && GET_MODE (op0) == TFmode) - { - if (! TARGET_HAS_XFLOATING_LIBS) - abort (); - - /* X_floating library comparison functions return - -1 unordered - 0 false - 1 true - Convert the compare against the raw return value. */ - - switch (code) - { - case UNORDERED: - cmp_code = EQ; - code = LT; - break; - case ORDERED: - cmp_code = EQ; - code = GE; - break; - case NE: - cmp_code = NE; - code = NE; - break; - default: - cmp_code = code; - code = GT; - break; - } - - op0 = alpha_emit_xfloating_compare (cmp_code, op0, op1); - op1 = const0_rtx; - alpha_compare.fp_p = 0; - } - - /* The general case: fold the comparison code to the types of compares - that we have, choosing the branch as necessary. */ - switch (code) - { - case EQ: case LE: case LT: case LEU: case LTU: - case UNORDERED: - /* We have these compares: */ - cmp_code = code, branch_code = NE; - break; - - case NE: - case ORDERED: - /* These must be reversed. */ - cmp_code = reverse_condition (code), branch_code = EQ; - break; - - case GE: case GT: case GEU: case GTU: - /* For FP, we swap them, for INT, we reverse them. */ - if (alpha_compare.fp_p) - { - cmp_code = swap_condition (code); - branch_code = NE; - tem = op0, op0 = op1, op1 = tem; - } - else - { - cmp_code = reverse_condition (code); - branch_code = EQ; - } - break; - - default: - abort (); - } - - if (alpha_compare.fp_p) - { - cmp_mode = DFmode; - if (flag_unsafe_math_optimizations) - { - /* When we are not as concerned about non-finite values, and we - are comparing against zero, we can branch directly. */ - if (op1 == CONST0_RTX (DFmode)) - cmp_code = NIL, branch_code = code; - else if (op0 == CONST0_RTX (DFmode)) - { - /* Undo the swap we probably did just above. */ - tem = op0, op0 = op1, op1 = tem; - branch_code = swap_condition (cmp_code); - cmp_code = NIL; - } - } - else - { - /* ??? We mark the branch mode to be CCmode to prevent the - compare and branch from being combined, since the compare - insn follows IEEE rules that the branch does not. */ - branch_mode = CCmode; - } - } - else - { - cmp_mode = DImode; - - /* The following optimizations are only for signed compares. */ - if (code != LEU && code != LTU && code != GEU && code != GTU) - { - /* Whee. Compare and branch against 0 directly. */ - if (op1 == const0_rtx) - cmp_code = NIL, branch_code = code; - - /* If the constants doesn't fit into an immediate, but can - be generated by lda/ldah, we adjust the argument and - compare against zero, so we can use beq/bne directly. */ - /* ??? Don't do this when comparing against symbols, otherwise - we'll reduce (&x == 0x1234) to (&x-0x1234 == 0), which will - be declared false out of hand (at least for non-weak). */ - else if (GET_CODE (op1) == CONST_INT - && (code == EQ || code == NE) - && !(symbolic_operand (op0, VOIDmode) - || (GET_CODE (op0) == REG && REG_POINTER (op0)))) - { - HOST_WIDE_INT v = INTVAL (op1), n = -v; - - if (! CONST_OK_FOR_LETTER_P (v, 'I') - && (CONST_OK_FOR_LETTER_P (n, 'K') - || CONST_OK_FOR_LETTER_P (n, 'L'))) - { - cmp_code = PLUS, branch_code = code; - op1 = GEN_INT (n); - } - } - } - - if (!reg_or_0_operand (op0, DImode)) - op0 = force_reg (DImode, op0); - if (cmp_code != PLUS && !reg_or_8bit_operand (op1, DImode)) - op1 = force_reg (DImode, op1); - } - - /* Emit an initial compare instruction, if necessary. */ - tem = op0; - if (cmp_code != NIL) - { - tem = gen_reg_rtx (cmp_mode); - emit_move_insn (tem, gen_rtx_fmt_ee (cmp_code, cmp_mode, op0, op1)); - } - - /* Zero the operands. */ - memset (&alpha_compare, 0, sizeof (alpha_compare)); - - /* Return the branch comparison. */ - return gen_rtx_fmt_ee (branch_code, branch_mode, tem, CONST0_RTX (cmp_mode)); -} - -/* Certain simplifications can be done to make invalid setcc operations - valid. Return the final comparison, or NULL if we can't work. */ - -rtx -alpha_emit_setcc (enum rtx_code code) -{ - enum rtx_code cmp_code; - rtx op0 = alpha_compare.op0, op1 = alpha_compare.op1; - int fp_p = alpha_compare.fp_p; - rtx tmp; - - /* Zero the operands. */ - memset (&alpha_compare, 0, sizeof (alpha_compare)); - - if (fp_p && GET_MODE (op0) == TFmode) - { - if (! TARGET_HAS_XFLOATING_LIBS) - abort (); - - /* X_floating library comparison functions return - -1 unordered - 0 false - 1 true - Convert the compare against the raw return value. */ - - if (code == UNORDERED || code == ORDERED) - cmp_code = EQ; - else - cmp_code = code; - - op0 = alpha_emit_xfloating_compare (cmp_code, op0, op1); - op1 = const0_rtx; - fp_p = 0; - - if (code == UNORDERED) - code = LT; - else if (code == ORDERED) - code = GE; - else - code = GT; - } - - if (fp_p && !TARGET_FIX) - return NULL_RTX; - - /* The general case: fold the comparison code to the types of compares - that we have, choosing the branch as necessary. */ - - cmp_code = NIL; - switch (code) - { - case EQ: case LE: case LT: case LEU: case LTU: - case UNORDERED: - /* We have these compares. */ - if (fp_p) - cmp_code = code, code = NE; - break; - - case NE: - if (!fp_p && op1 == const0_rtx) - break; - /* FALLTHRU */ - - case ORDERED: - cmp_code = reverse_condition (code); - code = EQ; - break; - - case GE: case GT: case GEU: case GTU: - /* These normally need swapping, but for integer zero we have - special patterns that recognize swapped operands. */ - if (!fp_p && op1 == const0_rtx) - break; - code = swap_condition (code); - if (fp_p) - cmp_code = code, code = NE; - tmp = op0, op0 = op1, op1 = tmp; - break; - - default: - abort (); - } - - if (!fp_p) - { - if (!register_operand (op0, DImode)) - op0 = force_reg (DImode, op0); - if (!reg_or_8bit_operand (op1, DImode)) - op1 = force_reg (DImode, op1); - } - - /* Emit an initial compare instruction, if necessary. */ - if (cmp_code != NIL) - { - enum machine_mode mode = fp_p ? DFmode : DImode; - - tmp = gen_reg_rtx (mode); - emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, tmp, - gen_rtx_fmt_ee (cmp_code, mode, op0, op1))); - - op0 = fp_p ? gen_lowpart (DImode, tmp) : tmp; - op1 = const0_rtx; - } - - /* Return the setcc comparison. */ - return gen_rtx_fmt_ee (code, DImode, op0, op1); -} - - -/* Rewrite a comparison against zero CMP of the form - (CODE (cc0) (const_int 0)) so it can be written validly in - a conditional move (if_then_else CMP ...). - If both of the operands that set cc0 are nonzero we must emit - an insn to perform the compare (it can't be done within - the conditional move). */ - -rtx -alpha_emit_conditional_move (rtx cmp, enum machine_mode mode) -{ - enum rtx_code code = GET_CODE (cmp); - enum rtx_code cmov_code = NE; - rtx op0 = alpha_compare.op0; - rtx op1 = alpha_compare.op1; - int fp_p = alpha_compare.fp_p; - enum machine_mode cmp_mode - = (GET_MODE (op0) == VOIDmode ? DImode : GET_MODE (op0)); - enum machine_mode cmp_op_mode = fp_p ? DFmode : DImode; - enum machine_mode cmov_mode = VOIDmode; - int local_fast_math = flag_unsafe_math_optimizations; - rtx tem; - - /* Zero the operands. */ - memset (&alpha_compare, 0, sizeof (alpha_compare)); - - if (fp_p != FLOAT_MODE_P (mode)) - { - enum rtx_code cmp_code; - - if (! TARGET_FIX) - return 0; - - /* If we have fp<->int register move instructions, do a cmov by - performing the comparison in fp registers, and move the - zero/nonzero value to integer registers, where we can then - use a normal cmov, or vice-versa. */ - - switch (code) - { - case EQ: case LE: case LT: case LEU: case LTU: - /* We have these compares. */ - cmp_code = code, code = NE; - break; - - case NE: - /* This must be reversed. */ - cmp_code = EQ, code = EQ; - break; - - case GE: case GT: case GEU: case GTU: - /* These normally need swapping, but for integer zero we have - special patterns that recognize swapped operands. */ - if (!fp_p && op1 == const0_rtx) - cmp_code = code, code = NE; - else - { - cmp_code = swap_condition (code); - code = NE; - tem = op0, op0 = op1, op1 = tem; - } - break; - - default: - abort (); - } - - tem = gen_reg_rtx (cmp_op_mode); - emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, tem, - gen_rtx_fmt_ee (cmp_code, cmp_op_mode, - op0, op1))); - - cmp_mode = cmp_op_mode = fp_p ? DImode : DFmode; - op0 = gen_lowpart (cmp_op_mode, tem); - op1 = CONST0_RTX (cmp_op_mode); - fp_p = !fp_p; - local_fast_math = 1; - } - - /* We may be able to use a conditional move directly. - This avoids emitting spurious compares. */ - if (signed_comparison_operator (cmp, VOIDmode) - && (!fp_p || local_fast_math) - && (op0 == CONST0_RTX (cmp_mode) || op1 == CONST0_RTX (cmp_mode))) - return gen_rtx_fmt_ee (code, VOIDmode, op0, op1); - - /* We can't put the comparison inside the conditional move; - emit a compare instruction and put that inside the - conditional move. Make sure we emit only comparisons we have; - swap or reverse as necessary. */ - - if (no_new_pseudos) - return NULL_RTX; - - switch (code) - { - case EQ: case LE: case LT: case LEU: case LTU: - /* We have these compares: */ - break; - - case NE: - /* This must be reversed. */ - code = reverse_condition (code); - cmov_code = EQ; - break; - - case GE: case GT: case GEU: case GTU: - /* These must be swapped. */ - if (op1 != CONST0_RTX (cmp_mode)) - { - code = swap_condition (code); - tem = op0, op0 = op1, op1 = tem; - } - break; - - default: - abort (); - } - - if (!fp_p) - { - if (!reg_or_0_operand (op0, DImode)) - op0 = force_reg (DImode, op0); - if (!reg_or_8bit_operand (op1, DImode)) - op1 = force_reg (DImode, op1); - } - - /* ??? We mark the branch mode to be CCmode to prevent the compare - and cmov from being combined, since the compare insn follows IEEE - rules that the cmov does not. */ - if (fp_p && !local_fast_math) - cmov_mode = CCmode; - - tem = gen_reg_rtx (cmp_op_mode); - emit_move_insn (tem, gen_rtx_fmt_ee (code, cmp_op_mode, op0, op1)); - return gen_rtx_fmt_ee (cmov_code, cmov_mode, tem, CONST0_RTX (cmp_op_mode)); -} - -/* Simplify a conditional move of two constants into a setcc with - arithmetic. This is done with a splitter since combine would - just undo the work if done during code generation. It also catches - cases we wouldn't have before cse. */ - -int -alpha_split_conditional_move (enum rtx_code code, rtx dest, rtx cond, - rtx t_rtx, rtx f_rtx) -{ - HOST_WIDE_INT t, f, diff; - enum machine_mode mode; - rtx target, subtarget, tmp; - - mode = GET_MODE (dest); - t = INTVAL (t_rtx); - f = INTVAL (f_rtx); - diff = t - f; - - if (((code == NE || code == EQ) && diff < 0) - || (code == GE || code == GT)) - { - code = reverse_condition (code); - diff = t, t = f, f = diff; - diff = t - f; - } - - subtarget = target = dest; - if (mode != DImode) - { - target = gen_lowpart (DImode, dest); - if (! no_new_pseudos) - subtarget = gen_reg_rtx (DImode); - else - subtarget = target; - } - /* Below, we must be careful to use copy_rtx on target and subtarget - in intermediate insns, as they may be a subreg rtx, which may not - be shared. */ - - if (f == 0 && exact_log2 (diff) > 0 - /* On EV6, we've got enough shifters to make non-arithmetic shifts - viable over a longer latency cmove. On EV5, the E0 slot is a - scarce resource, and on EV4 shift has the same latency as a cmove. */ - && (diff <= 8 || alpha_cpu == PROCESSOR_EV6)) - { - tmp = gen_rtx_fmt_ee (code, DImode, cond, const0_rtx); - emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, copy_rtx (subtarget), tmp)); - - tmp = gen_rtx_ASHIFT (DImode, copy_rtx (subtarget), - GEN_INT (exact_log2 (t))); - emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, target, tmp)); - } - else if (f == 0 && t == -1) - { - tmp = gen_rtx_fmt_ee (code, DImode, cond, const0_rtx); - emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, copy_rtx (subtarget), tmp)); - - emit_insn (gen_negdi2 (target, copy_rtx (subtarget))); - } - else if (diff == 1 || diff == 4 || diff == 8) - { - rtx add_op; - - tmp = gen_rtx_fmt_ee (code, DImode, cond, const0_rtx); - emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, copy_rtx (subtarget), tmp)); - - if (diff == 1) - emit_insn (gen_adddi3 (target, copy_rtx (subtarget), GEN_INT (f))); - else - { - add_op = GEN_INT (f); - if (sext_add_operand (add_op, mode)) - { - tmp = gen_rtx_MULT (DImode, copy_rtx (subtarget), - GEN_INT (diff)); - tmp = gen_rtx_PLUS (DImode, tmp, add_op); - emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, target, tmp)); - } - else - return 0; - } - } - else - return 0; - - return 1; -} - -/* Look up the function X_floating library function name for the - given operation. */ - -static const char * -alpha_lookup_xfloating_lib_func (enum rtx_code code) -{ - struct xfloating_op - { - const enum rtx_code code; - const char *const func; - }; - - static const struct xfloating_op vms_xfloating_ops[] = - { - { PLUS, "OTS$ADD_X" }, - { MINUS, "OTS$SUB_X" }, - { MULT, "OTS$MUL_X" }, - { DIV, "OTS$DIV_X" }, - { EQ, "OTS$EQL_X" }, - { NE, "OTS$NEQ_X" }, - { LT, "OTS$LSS_X" }, - { LE, "OTS$LEQ_X" }, - { GT, "OTS$GTR_X" }, - { GE, "OTS$GEQ_X" }, - { FIX, "OTS$CVTXQ" }, - { FLOAT, "OTS$CVTQX" }, - { UNSIGNED_FLOAT, "OTS$CVTQUX" }, - { FLOAT_EXTEND, "OTS$CVT_FLOAT_T_X" }, - { FLOAT_TRUNCATE, "OTS$CVT_FLOAT_X_T" }, - }; - - static const struct xfloating_op osf_xfloating_ops[] = - { - { PLUS, "_OtsAddX" }, - { MINUS, "_OtsSubX" }, - { MULT, "_OtsMulX" }, - { DIV, "_OtsDivX" }, - { EQ, "_OtsEqlX" }, - { NE, "_OtsNeqX" }, - { LT, "_OtsLssX" }, - { LE, "_OtsLeqX" }, - { GT, "_OtsGtrX" }, - { GE, "_OtsGeqX" }, - { FIX, "_OtsCvtXQ" }, - { FLOAT, "_OtsCvtQX" }, - { UNSIGNED_FLOAT, "_OtsCvtQUX" }, - { FLOAT_EXTEND, "_OtsConvertFloatTX" }, - { FLOAT_TRUNCATE, "_OtsConvertFloatXT" }, - }; - - const struct xfloating_op *ops; - const long n = ARRAY_SIZE (osf_xfloating_ops); - long i; - - /* How irritating. Nothing to key off for the table. Hardcode - knowledge of the G_floating routines. */ - if (TARGET_FLOAT_VAX) - { - if (TARGET_ABI_OPEN_VMS) - { - if (code == FLOAT_EXTEND) - return "OTS$CVT_FLOAT_G_X"; - if (code == FLOAT_TRUNCATE) - return "OTS$CVT_FLOAT_X_G"; - } - else - { - if (code == FLOAT_EXTEND) - return "_OtsConvertFloatGX"; - if (code == FLOAT_TRUNCATE) - return "_OtsConvertFloatXG"; - } - } - - if (TARGET_ABI_OPEN_VMS) - ops = vms_xfloating_ops; - else - ops = osf_xfloating_ops; - - for (i = 0; i < n; ++i) - if (ops[i].code == code) - return ops[i].func; - - abort(); -} - -/* Most X_floating operations take the rounding mode as an argument. - Compute that here. */ - -static int -alpha_compute_xfloating_mode_arg (enum rtx_code code, - enum alpha_fp_rounding_mode round) -{ - int mode; - - switch (round) - { - case ALPHA_FPRM_NORM: - mode = 2; - break; - case ALPHA_FPRM_MINF: - mode = 1; - break; - case ALPHA_FPRM_CHOP: - mode = 0; - break; - case ALPHA_FPRM_DYN: - mode = 4; - break; - default: - abort (); - - /* XXX For reference, round to +inf is mode = 3. */ - } - - if (code == FLOAT_TRUNCATE && alpha_fptm == ALPHA_FPTM_N) - mode |= 0x10000; - - return mode; -} - -/* Emit an X_floating library function call. - - Note that these functions do not follow normal calling conventions: - TFmode arguments are passed in two integer registers (as opposed to - indirect); TFmode return values appear in R16+R17. - - FUNC is the function name to call. - TARGET is where the output belongs. - OPERANDS are the inputs. - NOPERANDS is the count of inputs. - EQUIV is the expression equivalent for the function. -*/ - -static void -alpha_emit_xfloating_libcall (const char *func, rtx target, rtx operands[], - int noperands, rtx equiv) -{ - rtx usage = NULL_RTX, tmp, reg; - int regno = 16, i; - - start_sequence (); - - for (i = 0; i < noperands; ++i) - { - switch (GET_MODE (operands[i])) - { - case TFmode: - reg = gen_rtx_REG (TFmode, regno); - regno += 2; - break; - - case DFmode: - reg = gen_rtx_REG (DFmode, regno + 32); - regno += 1; - break; - - case VOIDmode: - if (GET_CODE (operands[i]) != CONST_INT) - abort (); - /* FALLTHRU */ - case DImode: - reg = gen_rtx_REG (DImode, regno); - regno += 1; - break; - - default: - abort (); - } - - emit_move_insn (reg, operands[i]); - usage = alloc_EXPR_LIST (0, gen_rtx_USE (VOIDmode, reg), usage); - } - - switch (GET_MODE (target)) - { - case TFmode: - reg = gen_rtx_REG (TFmode, 16); - break; - case DFmode: - reg = gen_rtx_REG (DFmode, 32); - break; - case DImode: - reg = gen_rtx_REG (DImode, 0); - break; - default: - abort (); - } - - tmp = gen_rtx_MEM (QImode, init_one_libfunc (func)); - tmp = emit_call_insn (GEN_CALL_VALUE (reg, tmp, const0_rtx, - const0_rtx, const0_rtx)); - CALL_INSN_FUNCTION_USAGE (tmp) = usage; - - tmp = get_insns (); - end_sequence (); - - emit_libcall_block (tmp, target, reg, equiv); -} - -/* Emit an X_floating library function call for arithmetic (+,-,*,/). */ - -void -alpha_emit_xfloating_arith (enum rtx_code code, rtx operands[]) -{ - const char *func; - int mode; - rtx out_operands[3]; - - func = alpha_lookup_xfloating_lib_func (code); - mode = alpha_compute_xfloating_mode_arg (code, alpha_fprm); - - out_operands[0] = operands[1]; - out_operands[1] = operands[2]; - out_operands[2] = GEN_INT (mode); - alpha_emit_xfloating_libcall (func, operands[0], out_operands, 3, - gen_rtx_fmt_ee (code, TFmode, operands[1], - operands[2])); -} - -/* Emit an X_floating library function call for a comparison. */ - -static rtx -alpha_emit_xfloating_compare (enum rtx_code code, rtx op0, rtx op1) -{ - const char *func; - rtx out, operands[2]; - - func = alpha_lookup_xfloating_lib_func (code); - - operands[0] = op0; - operands[1] = op1; - out = gen_reg_rtx (DImode); - - /* ??? Strange mode for equiv because what's actually returned - is -1,0,1, not a proper boolean value. */ - alpha_emit_xfloating_libcall (func, out, operands, 2, - gen_rtx_fmt_ee (code, CCmode, op0, op1)); - - return out; -} - -/* Emit an X_floating library function call for a conversion. */ - -void -alpha_emit_xfloating_cvt (enum rtx_code orig_code, rtx operands[]) -{ - int noperands = 1, mode; - rtx out_operands[2]; - const char *func; - enum rtx_code code = orig_code; - - if (code == UNSIGNED_FIX) - code = FIX; - - func = alpha_lookup_xfloating_lib_func (code); - - out_operands[0] = operands[1]; - - switch (code) - { - case FIX: - mode = alpha_compute_xfloating_mode_arg (code, ALPHA_FPRM_CHOP); - out_operands[1] = GEN_INT (mode); - noperands = 2; - break; - case FLOAT_TRUNCATE: - mode = alpha_compute_xfloating_mode_arg (code, alpha_fprm); - out_operands[1] = GEN_INT (mode); - noperands = 2; - break; - default: - break; - } - - alpha_emit_xfloating_libcall (func, operands[0], out_operands, noperands, - gen_rtx_fmt_e (orig_code, - GET_MODE (operands[0]), - operands[1])); -} - -/* Split a TFmode OP[1] into DImode OP[2,3] and likewise for - OP[0] into OP[0,1]. Naturally, output operand ordering is - little-endian. */ - -void -alpha_split_tfmode_pair (rtx operands[4]) -{ - if (GET_CODE (operands[1]) == REG) - { - operands[3] = gen_rtx_REG (DImode, REGNO (operands[1]) + 1); - operands[2] = gen_rtx_REG (DImode, REGNO (operands[1])); - } - else if (GET_CODE (operands[1]) == MEM) - { - operands[3] = adjust_address (operands[1], DImode, 8); - operands[2] = adjust_address (operands[1], DImode, 0); - } - else if (operands[1] == CONST0_RTX (TFmode)) - operands[2] = operands[3] = const0_rtx; - else - abort (); - - if (GET_CODE (operands[0]) == REG) - { - operands[1] = gen_rtx_REG (DImode, REGNO (operands[0]) + 1); - operands[0] = gen_rtx_REG (DImode, REGNO (operands[0])); - } - else if (GET_CODE (operands[0]) == MEM) - { - operands[1] = adjust_address (operands[0], DImode, 8); - operands[0] = adjust_address (operands[0], DImode, 0); - } - else - abort (); -} - -/* Implement negtf2 or abstf2. Op0 is destination, op1 is source, - op2 is a register containing the sign bit, operation is the - logical operation to be performed. */ - -void -alpha_split_tfmode_frobsign (rtx operands[3], rtx (*operation) (rtx, rtx, rtx)) -{ - rtx high_bit = operands[2]; - rtx scratch; - int move; - - alpha_split_tfmode_pair (operands); - - /* Detect three flavors of operand overlap. */ - move = 1; - if (rtx_equal_p (operands[0], operands[2])) - move = 0; - else if (rtx_equal_p (operands[1], operands[2])) - { - if (rtx_equal_p (operands[0], high_bit)) - move = 2; - else - move = -1; - } - - if (move < 0) - emit_move_insn (operands[0], operands[2]); - - /* ??? If the destination overlaps both source tf and high_bit, then - assume source tf is dead in its entirety and use the other half - for a scratch register. Otherwise "scratch" is just the proper - destination register. */ - scratch = operands[move < 2 ? 1 : 3]; - - emit_insn ((*operation) (scratch, high_bit, operands[3])); - - if (move > 0) - { - emit_move_insn (operands[0], operands[2]); - if (move > 1) - emit_move_insn (operands[1], scratch); - } -} - -/* Use ext[wlq][lh] as the Architecture Handbook describes for extracting - unaligned data: - - unsigned: signed: - word: ldq_u r1,X(r11) ldq_u r1,X(r11) - ldq_u r2,X+1(r11) ldq_u r2,X+1(r11) - lda r3,X(r11) lda r3,X+2(r11) - extwl r1,r3,r1 extql r1,r3,r1 - extwh r2,r3,r2 extqh r2,r3,r2 - or r1.r2.r1 or r1,r2,r1 - sra r1,48,r1 - - long: ldq_u r1,X(r11) ldq_u r1,X(r11) - ldq_u r2,X+3(r11) ldq_u r2,X+3(r11) - lda r3,X(r11) lda r3,X(r11) - extll r1,r3,r1 extll r1,r3,r1 - extlh r2,r3,r2 extlh r2,r3,r2 - or r1.r2.r1 addl r1,r2,r1 - - quad: ldq_u r1,X(r11) - ldq_u r2,X+7(r11) - lda r3,X(r11) - extql r1,r3,r1 - extqh r2,r3,r2 - or r1.r2.r1 -*/ - -void -alpha_expand_unaligned_load (rtx tgt, rtx mem, HOST_WIDE_INT size, - HOST_WIDE_INT ofs, int sign) -{ - rtx meml, memh, addr, extl, exth, tmp, mema; - enum machine_mode mode; - - meml = gen_reg_rtx (DImode); - memh = gen_reg_rtx (DImode); - addr = gen_reg_rtx (DImode); - extl = gen_reg_rtx (DImode); - exth = gen_reg_rtx (DImode); - - mema = XEXP (mem, 0); - if (GET_CODE (mema) == LO_SUM) - mema = force_reg (Pmode, mema); - - /* AND addresses cannot be in any alias set, since they may implicitly - alias surrounding code. Ideally we'd have some alias set that - covered all types except those with alignment 8 or higher. */ - - tmp = change_address (mem, DImode, - gen_rtx_AND (DImode, - plus_constant (mema, ofs), - GEN_INT (-8))); - set_mem_alias_set (tmp, 0); - emit_move_insn (meml, tmp); - - tmp = change_address (mem, DImode, - gen_rtx_AND (DImode, - plus_constant (mema, ofs + size - 1), - GEN_INT (-8))); - set_mem_alias_set (tmp, 0); - emit_move_insn (memh, tmp); - - if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN && sign && (size == 2 || size == 4)) - { - emit_move_insn (addr, plus_constant (mema, -1)); - - emit_insn (gen_extqh_be (extl, meml, addr)); - emit_insn (gen_extxl_be (exth, memh, GEN_INT (64), addr)); - - addr = expand_binop (DImode, ior_optab, extl, exth, tgt, 1, OPTAB_WIDEN); - addr = expand_binop (DImode, ashr_optab, addr, GEN_INT (64 - size*8), - addr, 1, OPTAB_WIDEN); - } - else if (sign && size == 2) - { - emit_move_insn (addr, plus_constant (mema, ofs+2)); - - emit_insn (gen_extxl_le (extl, meml, GEN_INT (64), addr)); - emit_insn (gen_extqh_le (exth, memh, addr)); - - /* We must use tgt here for the target. Alpha-vms port fails if we use - addr for the target, because addr is marked as a pointer and combine - knows that pointers are always sign-extended 32 bit values. */ - addr = expand_binop (DImode, ior_optab, extl, exth, tgt, 1, OPTAB_WIDEN); - addr = expand_binop (DImode, ashr_optab, addr, GEN_INT (48), - addr, 1, OPTAB_WIDEN); - } - else - { - if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN) - { - emit_move_insn (addr, plus_constant (mema, ofs+size-1)); - switch ((int) size) - { - case 2: - emit_insn (gen_extwh_be (extl, meml, addr)); - mode = HImode; - break; - - case 4: - emit_insn (gen_extlh_be (extl, meml, addr)); - mode = SImode; - break; - - case 8: - emit_insn (gen_extqh_be (extl, meml, addr)); - mode = DImode; - break; - - default: - abort (); - } - emit_insn (gen_extxl_be (exth, memh, GEN_INT (size*8), addr)); - } - else - { - emit_move_insn (addr, plus_constant (mema, ofs)); - emit_insn (gen_extxl_le (extl, meml, GEN_INT (size*8), addr)); - switch ((int) size) - { - case 2: - emit_insn (gen_extwh_le (exth, memh, addr)); - mode = HImode; - break; - - case 4: - emit_insn (gen_extlh_le (exth, memh, addr)); - mode = SImode; - break; - - case 8: - emit_insn (gen_extqh_le (exth, memh, addr)); - mode = DImode; - break; - - default: - abort(); - } - } - - addr = expand_binop (mode, ior_optab, gen_lowpart (mode, extl), - gen_lowpart (mode, exth), gen_lowpart (mode, tgt), - sign, OPTAB_WIDEN); - } - - if (addr != tgt) - emit_move_insn (tgt, gen_lowpart(GET_MODE (tgt), addr)); -} - -/* Similarly, use ins and msk instructions to perform unaligned stores. */ - -void -alpha_expand_unaligned_store (rtx dst, rtx src, - HOST_WIDE_INT size, HOST_WIDE_INT ofs) -{ - rtx dstl, dsth, addr, insl, insh, meml, memh, dsta; - - dstl = gen_reg_rtx (DImode); - dsth = gen_reg_rtx (DImode); - insl = gen_reg_rtx (DImode); - insh = gen_reg_rtx (DImode); - - dsta = XEXP (dst, 0); - if (GET_CODE (dsta) == LO_SUM) - dsta = force_reg (Pmode, dsta); - - /* AND addresses cannot be in any alias set, since they may implicitly - alias surrounding code. Ideally we'd have some alias set that - covered all types except those with alignment 8 or higher. */ - - meml = change_address (dst, DImode, - gen_rtx_AND (DImode, - plus_constant (dsta, ofs), - GEN_INT (-8))); - set_mem_alias_set (meml, 0); - - memh = change_address (dst, DImode, - gen_rtx_AND (DImode, - plus_constant (dsta, ofs + size - 1), - GEN_INT (-8))); - set_mem_alias_set (memh, 0); - - emit_move_insn (dsth, memh); - emit_move_insn (dstl, meml); - if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN) - { - addr = copy_addr_to_reg (plus_constant (dsta, ofs+size-1)); - - if (src != const0_rtx) - { - switch ((int) size) - { - case 2: - emit_insn (gen_inswl_be (insh, gen_lowpart (HImode,src), addr)); - break; - case 4: - emit_insn (gen_insll_be (insh, gen_lowpart (SImode,src), addr)); - break; - case 8: - emit_insn (gen_insql_be (insh, gen_lowpart (DImode,src), addr)); - break; - } - emit_insn (gen_insxh (insl, gen_lowpart (DImode, src), - GEN_INT (size*8), addr)); - } - - switch ((int) size) - { - case 2: - emit_insn (gen_mskxl_be (dsth, dsth, GEN_INT (0xffff), addr)); - break; - case 4: - { - rtx msk = immed_double_const (0xffffffff, 0, DImode); - emit_insn (gen_mskxl_be (dsth, dsth, msk, addr)); - break; - } - case 8: - emit_insn (gen_mskxl_be (dsth, dsth, constm1_rtx, addr)); - break; - } - - emit_insn (gen_mskxh (dstl, dstl, GEN_INT (size*8), addr)); - } - else - { - addr = copy_addr_to_reg (plus_constant (dsta, ofs)); - - if (src != const0_rtx) - { - emit_insn (gen_insxh (insh, gen_lowpart (DImode, src), - GEN_INT (size*8), addr)); - - switch ((int) size) - { - case 2: - emit_insn (gen_inswl_le (insl, gen_lowpart (HImode, src), addr)); - break; - case 4: - emit_insn (gen_insll_le (insl, gen_lowpart (SImode, src), addr)); - break; - case 8: - emit_insn (gen_insql_le (insl, src, addr)); - break; - } - } - - emit_insn (gen_mskxh (dsth, dsth, GEN_INT (size*8), addr)); - - switch ((int) size) - { - case 2: - emit_insn (gen_mskxl_le (dstl, dstl, GEN_INT (0xffff), addr)); - break; - case 4: - { - rtx msk = immed_double_const (0xffffffff, 0, DImode); - emit_insn (gen_mskxl_le (dstl, dstl, msk, addr)); - break; - } - case 8: - emit_insn (gen_mskxl_le (dstl, dstl, constm1_rtx, addr)); - break; - } - } - - if (src != const0_rtx) - { - dsth = expand_binop (DImode, ior_optab, insh, dsth, dsth, 0, OPTAB_WIDEN); - dstl = expand_binop (DImode, ior_optab, insl, dstl, dstl, 0, OPTAB_WIDEN); - } - - if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN) - { - emit_move_insn (meml, dstl); - emit_move_insn (memh, dsth); - } - else - { - /* Must store high before low for degenerate case of aligned. */ - emit_move_insn (memh, dsth); - emit_move_insn (meml, dstl); - } -} - -/* The block move code tries to maximize speed by separating loads and - stores at the expense of register pressure: we load all of the data - before we store it back out. There are two secondary effects worth - mentioning, that this speeds copying to/from aligned and unaligned - buffers, and that it makes the code significantly easier to write. */ - -#define MAX_MOVE_WORDS 8 - -/* Load an integral number of consecutive unaligned quadwords. */ - -static void -alpha_expand_unaligned_load_words (rtx *out_regs, rtx smem, - HOST_WIDE_INT words, HOST_WIDE_INT ofs) -{ - rtx const im8 = GEN_INT (-8); - rtx const i64 = GEN_INT (64); - rtx ext_tmps[MAX_MOVE_WORDS], data_regs[MAX_MOVE_WORDS+1]; - rtx sreg, areg, tmp, smema; - HOST_WIDE_INT i; - - smema = XEXP (smem, 0); - if (GET_CODE (smema) == LO_SUM) - smema = force_reg (Pmode, smema); - - /* Generate all the tmp registers we need. */ - for (i = 0; i < words; ++i) - { - data_regs[i] = out_regs[i]; - ext_tmps[i] = gen_reg_rtx (DImode); - } - data_regs[words] = gen_reg_rtx (DImode); - - if (ofs != 0) - smem = adjust_address (smem, GET_MODE (smem), ofs); - - /* Load up all of the source data. */ - for (i = 0; i < words; ++i) - { - tmp = change_address (smem, DImode, - gen_rtx_AND (DImode, - plus_constant (smema, 8*i), - im8)); - set_mem_alias_set (tmp, 0); - emit_move_insn (data_regs[i], tmp); - } - - tmp = change_address (smem, DImode, - gen_rtx_AND (DImode, - plus_constant (smema, 8*words - 1), - im8)); - set_mem_alias_set (tmp, 0); - emit_move_insn (data_regs[words], tmp); - - /* Extract the half-word fragments. Unfortunately DEC decided to make - extxh with offset zero a noop instead of zeroing the register, so - we must take care of that edge condition ourselves with cmov. */ - - sreg = copy_addr_to_reg (smema); - areg = expand_binop (DImode, and_optab, sreg, GEN_INT (7), NULL, - 1, OPTAB_WIDEN); - if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN) - emit_move_insn (sreg, plus_constant (sreg, 7)); - for (i = 0; i < words; ++i) - { - if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN) - { - emit_insn (gen_extqh_be (data_regs[i], data_regs[i], sreg)); - emit_insn (gen_extxl_be (ext_tmps[i], data_regs[i+1], i64, sreg)); - } - else - { - emit_insn (gen_extxl_le (data_regs[i], data_regs[i], i64, sreg)); - emit_insn (gen_extqh_le (ext_tmps[i], data_regs[i+1], sreg)); - } - emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, ext_tmps[i], - gen_rtx_IF_THEN_ELSE (DImode, - gen_rtx_EQ (DImode, areg, - const0_rtx), - const0_rtx, ext_tmps[i]))); - } - - /* Merge the half-words into whole words. */ - for (i = 0; i < words; ++i) - { - out_regs[i] = expand_binop (DImode, ior_optab, data_regs[i], - ext_tmps[i], data_regs[i], 1, OPTAB_WIDEN); - } -} - -/* Store an integral number of consecutive unaligned quadwords. DATA_REGS - may be NULL to store zeros. */ - -static void -alpha_expand_unaligned_store_words (rtx *data_regs, rtx dmem, - HOST_WIDE_INT words, HOST_WIDE_INT ofs) -{ - rtx const im8 = GEN_INT (-8); - rtx const i64 = GEN_INT (64); - rtx ins_tmps[MAX_MOVE_WORDS]; - rtx st_tmp_1, st_tmp_2, dreg; - rtx st_addr_1, st_addr_2, dmema; - HOST_WIDE_INT i; - - dmema = XEXP (dmem, 0); - if (GET_CODE (dmema) == LO_SUM) - dmema = force_reg (Pmode, dmema); - - /* Generate all the tmp registers we need. */ - if (data_regs != NULL) - for (i = 0; i < words; ++i) - ins_tmps[i] = gen_reg_rtx(DImode); - st_tmp_1 = gen_reg_rtx(DImode); - st_tmp_2 = gen_reg_rtx(DImode); - - if (ofs != 0) - dmem = adjust_address (dmem, GET_MODE (dmem), ofs); - - st_addr_2 = change_address (dmem, DImode, - gen_rtx_AND (DImode, - plus_constant (dmema, words*8 - 1), - im8)); - set_mem_alias_set (st_addr_2, 0); - - st_addr_1 = change_address (dmem, DImode, - gen_rtx_AND (DImode, dmema, im8)); - set_mem_alias_set (st_addr_1, 0); - - /* Load up the destination end bits. */ - emit_move_insn (st_tmp_2, st_addr_2); - emit_move_insn (st_tmp_1, st_addr_1); - - /* Shift the input data into place. */ - dreg = copy_addr_to_reg (dmema); - if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN) - emit_move_insn (dreg, plus_constant (dreg, 7)); - if (data_regs != NULL) - { - for (i = words-1; i >= 0; --i) - { - if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN) - { - emit_insn (gen_insql_be (ins_tmps[i], data_regs[i], dreg)); - emit_insn (gen_insxh (data_regs[i], data_regs[i], i64, dreg)); - } - else - { - emit_insn (gen_insxh (ins_tmps[i], data_regs[i], i64, dreg)); - emit_insn (gen_insql_le (data_regs[i], data_regs[i], dreg)); - } - } - for (i = words-1; i > 0; --i) - { - ins_tmps[i-1] = expand_binop (DImode, ior_optab, data_regs[i], - ins_tmps[i-1], ins_tmps[i-1], 1, - OPTAB_WIDEN); - } - } - - /* Split and merge the ends with the destination data. */ - if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN) - { - emit_insn (gen_mskxl_be (st_tmp_2, st_tmp_2, constm1_rtx, dreg)); - emit_insn (gen_mskxh (st_tmp_1, st_tmp_1, i64, dreg)); - } - else - { - emit_insn (gen_mskxh (st_tmp_2, st_tmp_2, i64, dreg)); - emit_insn (gen_mskxl_le (st_tmp_1, st_tmp_1, constm1_rtx, dreg)); - } - - if (data_regs != NULL) - { - st_tmp_2 = expand_binop (DImode, ior_optab, st_tmp_2, ins_tmps[words-1], - st_tmp_2, 1, OPTAB_WIDEN); - st_tmp_1 = expand_binop (DImode, ior_optab, st_tmp_1, data_regs[0], - st_tmp_1, 1, OPTAB_WIDEN); - } - - /* Store it all. */ - if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN) - emit_move_insn (st_addr_1, st_tmp_1); - else - emit_move_insn (st_addr_2, st_tmp_2); - for (i = words-1; i > 0; --i) - { - rtx tmp = change_address (dmem, DImode, - gen_rtx_AND (DImode, - plus_constant(dmema, - WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN ? i*8-1 : i*8), - im8)); - set_mem_alias_set (tmp, 0); - emit_move_insn (tmp, data_regs ? ins_tmps[i-1] : const0_rtx); - } - if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN) - emit_move_insn (st_addr_2, st_tmp_2); - else - emit_move_insn (st_addr_1, st_tmp_1); -} - - -/* Expand string/block move operations. - - operands[0] is the pointer to the destination. - operands[1] is the pointer to the source. - operands[2] is the number of bytes to move. - operands[3] is the alignment. */ - -int -alpha_expand_block_move (rtx operands[]) -{ - rtx bytes_rtx = operands[2]; - rtx align_rtx = operands[3]; - HOST_WIDE_INT orig_bytes = INTVAL (bytes_rtx); - HOST_WIDE_INT bytes = orig_bytes; - HOST_WIDE_INT src_align = INTVAL (align_rtx) * BITS_PER_UNIT; - HOST_WIDE_INT dst_align = src_align; - rtx orig_src = operands[1]; - rtx orig_dst = operands[0]; - rtx data_regs[2 * MAX_MOVE_WORDS + 16]; - rtx tmp; - unsigned int i, words, ofs, nregs = 0; - - if (orig_bytes <= 0) - return 1; - else if (orig_bytes > MAX_MOVE_WORDS * UNITS_PER_WORD) - return 0; - - /* Look for additional alignment information from recorded register info. */ - - tmp = XEXP (orig_src, 0); - if (GET_CODE (tmp) == REG) - src_align = MAX (src_align, REGNO_POINTER_ALIGN (REGNO (tmp))); - else if (GET_CODE (tmp) == PLUS - && GET_CODE (XEXP (tmp, 0)) == REG - && GET_CODE (XEXP (tmp, 1)) == CONST_INT) - { - unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT c = INTVAL (XEXP (tmp, 1)); - unsigned int a = REGNO_POINTER_ALIGN (REGNO (XEXP (tmp, 0))); - - if (a > src_align) - { - if (a >= 64 && c % 8 == 0) - src_align = 64; - else if (a >= 32 && c % 4 == 0) - src_align = 32; - else if (a >= 16 && c % 2 == 0) - src_align = 16; - } - } - - tmp = XEXP (orig_dst, 0); - if (GET_CODE (tmp) == REG) - dst_align = MAX (dst_align, REGNO_POINTER_ALIGN (REGNO (tmp))); - else if (GET_CODE (tmp) == PLUS - && GET_CODE (XEXP (tmp, 0)) == REG - && GET_CODE (XEXP (tmp, 1)) == CONST_INT) - { - unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT c = INTVAL (XEXP (tmp, 1)); - unsigned int a = REGNO_POINTER_ALIGN (REGNO (XEXP (tmp, 0))); - - if (a > dst_align) - { - if (a >= 64 && c % 8 == 0) - dst_align = 64; - else if (a >= 32 && c % 4 == 0) - dst_align = 32; - else if (a >= 16 && c % 2 == 0) - dst_align = 16; - } - } - - /* Load the entire block into registers. */ - if (GET_CODE (XEXP (orig_src, 0)) == ADDRESSOF) - { - enum machine_mode mode; - - tmp = XEXP (XEXP (orig_src, 0), 0); - - /* Don't use the existing register if we're reading more than - is held in the register. Nor if there is not a mode that - handles the exact size. */ - mode = mode_for_size (bytes * BITS_PER_UNIT, MODE_INT, 1); - if (GET_CODE (tmp) == REG - && mode != BLKmode - && GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (tmp)) >= bytes) - { - if (mode == TImode) - { - data_regs[nregs] = gen_lowpart (DImode, tmp); - data_regs[nregs + 1] = gen_highpart (DImode, tmp); - nregs += 2; - } - else - data_regs[nregs++] = gen_lowpart (mode, tmp); - - goto src_done; - } - - /* No appropriate mode; fall back on memory. */ - orig_src = replace_equiv_address (orig_src, - copy_addr_to_reg (XEXP (orig_src, 0))); - src_align = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (tmp)); - } - - ofs = 0; - if (src_align >= 64 && bytes >= 8) - { - words = bytes / 8; - - for (i = 0; i < words; ++i) - data_regs[nregs + i] = gen_reg_rtx (DImode); - - for (i = 0; i < words; ++i) - emit_move_insn (data_regs[nregs + i], - adjust_address (orig_src, DImode, ofs + i * 8)); - - nregs += words; - bytes -= words * 8; - ofs += words * 8; - } - - if (src_align >= 32 && bytes >= 4) - { - words = bytes / 4; - - for (i = 0; i < words; ++i) - data_regs[nregs + i] = gen_reg_rtx (SImode); - - for (i = 0; i < words; ++i) - emit_move_insn (data_regs[nregs + i], - adjust_address (orig_src, SImode, ofs + i * 4)); - - nregs += words; - bytes -= words * 4; - ofs += words * 4; - } - - if (bytes >= 8) - { - words = bytes / 8; - - for (i = 0; i < words+1; ++i) - data_regs[nregs + i] = gen_reg_rtx (DImode); - - alpha_expand_unaligned_load_words (data_regs + nregs, orig_src, - words, ofs); - - nregs += words; - bytes -= words * 8; - ofs += words * 8; - } - - if (! TARGET_BWX && bytes >= 4) - { - data_regs[nregs++] = tmp = gen_reg_rtx (SImode); - alpha_expand_unaligned_load (tmp, orig_src, 4, ofs, 0); - bytes -= 4; - ofs += 4; - } - - if (bytes >= 2) - { - if (src_align >= 16) - { - do { - data_regs[nregs++] = tmp = gen_reg_rtx (HImode); - emit_move_insn (tmp, adjust_address (orig_src, HImode, ofs)); - bytes -= 2; - ofs += 2; - } while (bytes >= 2); - } - else if (! TARGET_BWX) - { - data_regs[nregs++] = tmp = gen_reg_rtx (HImode); - alpha_expand_unaligned_load (tmp, orig_src, 2, ofs, 0); - bytes -= 2; - ofs += 2; - } - } - - while (bytes > 0) - { - data_regs[nregs++] = tmp = gen_reg_rtx (QImode); - emit_move_insn (tmp, adjust_address (orig_src, QImode, ofs)); - bytes -= 1; - ofs += 1; - } - - src_done: - - if (nregs > ARRAY_SIZE (data_regs)) - abort (); - - /* Now save it back out again. */ - - i = 0, ofs = 0; - - if (GET_CODE (XEXP (orig_dst, 0)) == ADDRESSOF) - { - enum machine_mode mode; - tmp = XEXP (XEXP (orig_dst, 0), 0); - - mode = mode_for_size (orig_bytes * BITS_PER_UNIT, MODE_INT, 1); - if (GET_CODE (tmp) == REG && GET_MODE (tmp) == mode) - { - if (nregs == 1) - { - emit_move_insn (tmp, data_regs[0]); - i = 1; - goto dst_done; - } - - else if (nregs == 2 && mode == TImode) - { - /* Undo the subregging done above when copying between - two TImode registers. */ - if (GET_CODE (data_regs[0]) == SUBREG - && GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (data_regs[0])) == TImode) - emit_move_insn (tmp, SUBREG_REG (data_regs[0])); - else - { - rtx seq; - - start_sequence (); - emit_move_insn (gen_lowpart (DImode, tmp), data_regs[0]); - emit_move_insn (gen_highpart (DImode, tmp), data_regs[1]); - seq = get_insns (); - end_sequence (); - - emit_no_conflict_block (seq, tmp, data_regs[0], - data_regs[1], NULL_RTX); - } - - i = 2; - goto dst_done; - } - } - - /* ??? If nregs > 1, consider reconstructing the word in regs. */ - /* ??? Optimize mode < dst_mode with strict_low_part. */ - - /* No appropriate mode; fall back on memory. We can speed things - up by recognizing extra alignment information. */ - orig_dst = replace_equiv_address (orig_dst, - copy_addr_to_reg (XEXP (orig_dst, 0))); - dst_align = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (tmp)); - } - - /* Write out the data in whatever chunks reading the source allowed. */ - if (dst_align >= 64) - { - while (i < nregs && GET_MODE (data_regs[i]) == DImode) - { - emit_move_insn (adjust_address (orig_dst, DImode, ofs), - data_regs[i]); - ofs += 8; - i++; - } - } - - if (dst_align >= 32) - { - /* If the source has remaining DImode regs, write them out in - two pieces. */ - while (i < nregs && GET_MODE (data_regs[i]) == DImode) - { - tmp = expand_binop (DImode, lshr_optab, data_regs[i], GEN_INT (32), - NULL_RTX, 1, OPTAB_WIDEN); - - emit_move_insn (adjust_address (orig_dst, SImode, ofs), - gen_lowpart (SImode, data_regs[i])); - emit_move_insn (adjust_address (orig_dst, SImode, ofs + 4), - gen_lowpart (SImode, tmp)); - ofs += 8; - i++; - } - - while (i < nregs && GET_MODE (data_regs[i]) == SImode) - { - emit_move_insn (adjust_address (orig_dst, SImode, ofs), - data_regs[i]); - ofs += 4; - i++; - } - } - - if (i < nregs && GET_MODE (data_regs[i]) == DImode) - { - /* Write out a remaining block of words using unaligned methods. */ - - for (words = 1; i + words < nregs; words++) - if (GET_MODE (data_regs[i + words]) != DImode) - break; - - if (words == 1) - alpha_expand_unaligned_store (orig_dst, data_regs[i], 8, ofs); - else - alpha_expand_unaligned_store_words (data_regs + i, orig_dst, - words, ofs); - - i += words; - ofs += words * 8; - } - - /* Due to the above, this won't be aligned. */ - /* ??? If we have more than one of these, consider constructing full - words in registers and using alpha_expand_unaligned_store_words. */ - while (i < nregs && GET_MODE (data_regs[i]) == SImode) - { - alpha_expand_unaligned_store (orig_dst, data_regs[i], 4, ofs); - ofs += 4; - i++; - } - - if (dst_align >= 16) - while (i < nregs && GET_MODE (data_regs[i]) == HImode) - { - emit_move_insn (adjust_address (orig_dst, HImode, ofs), data_regs[i]); - i++; - ofs += 2; - } - else - while (i < nregs && GET_MODE (data_regs[i]) == HImode) - { - alpha_expand_unaligned_store (orig_dst, data_regs[i], 2, ofs); - i++; - ofs += 2; - } - - while (i < nregs && GET_MODE (data_regs[i]) == QImode) - { - emit_move_insn (adjust_address (orig_dst, QImode, ofs), data_regs[i]); - i++; - ofs += 1; - } - - dst_done: - - if (i != nregs) - abort (); - - return 1; -} - -int -alpha_expand_block_clear (rtx operands[]) -{ - rtx bytes_rtx = operands[1]; - rtx align_rtx = operands[2]; - HOST_WIDE_INT orig_bytes = INTVAL (bytes_rtx); - HOST_WIDE_INT bytes = orig_bytes; - HOST_WIDE_INT align = INTVAL (align_rtx) * BITS_PER_UNIT; - HOST_WIDE_INT alignofs = 0; - rtx orig_dst = operands[0]; - rtx tmp; - int i, words, ofs = 0; - - if (orig_bytes <= 0) - return 1; - if (orig_bytes > MAX_MOVE_WORDS * UNITS_PER_WORD) - return 0; - - /* Look for stricter alignment. */ - tmp = XEXP (orig_dst, 0); - if (GET_CODE (tmp) == REG) - align = MAX (align, REGNO_POINTER_ALIGN (REGNO (tmp))); - else if (GET_CODE (tmp) == PLUS - && GET_CODE (XEXP (tmp, 0)) == REG - && GET_CODE (XEXP (tmp, 1)) == CONST_INT) - { - HOST_WIDE_INT c = INTVAL (XEXP (tmp, 1)); - int a = REGNO_POINTER_ALIGN (REGNO (XEXP (tmp, 0))); - - if (a > align) - { - if (a >= 64) - align = a, alignofs = 8 - c % 8; - else if (a >= 32) - align = a, alignofs = 4 - c % 4; - else if (a >= 16) - align = a, alignofs = 2 - c % 2; - } - } - else if (GET_CODE (tmp) == ADDRESSOF) - { - enum machine_mode mode; - - mode = mode_for_size (bytes * BITS_PER_UNIT, MODE_INT, 1); - if (GET_MODE (XEXP (tmp, 0)) == mode) - { - emit_move_insn (XEXP (tmp, 0), const0_rtx); - return 1; - } - - /* No appropriate mode; fall back on memory. */ - orig_dst = replace_equiv_address (orig_dst, copy_addr_to_reg (tmp)); - align = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (tmp, 0))); - } - - /* Handle an unaligned prefix first. */ - - if (alignofs > 0) - { -#if HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT >= 64 - /* Given that alignofs is bounded by align, the only time BWX could - generate three stores is for a 7 byte fill. Prefer two individual - stores over a load/mask/store sequence. */ - if ((!TARGET_BWX || alignofs == 7) - && align >= 32 - && !(alignofs == 4 && bytes >= 4)) - { - enum machine_mode mode = (align >= 64 ? DImode : SImode); - int inv_alignofs = (align >= 64 ? 8 : 4) - alignofs; - rtx mem, tmp; - HOST_WIDE_INT mask; - - mem = adjust_address (orig_dst, mode, ofs - inv_alignofs); - set_mem_alias_set (mem, 0); - - mask = ~(~(HOST_WIDE_INT)0 << (inv_alignofs * 8)); - if (bytes < alignofs) - { - mask |= ~(HOST_WIDE_INT)0 << ((inv_alignofs + bytes) * 8); - ofs += bytes; - bytes = 0; - } - else - { - bytes -= alignofs; - ofs += alignofs; - } - alignofs = 0; - - tmp = expand_binop (mode, and_optab, mem, GEN_INT (mask), - NULL_RTX, 1, OPTAB_WIDEN); - - emit_move_insn (mem, tmp); - } -#endif - - if (TARGET_BWX && (alignofs & 1) && bytes >= 1) - { - emit_move_insn (adjust_address (orig_dst, QImode, ofs), const0_rtx); - bytes -= 1; - ofs += 1; - alignofs -= 1; - } - if (TARGET_BWX && align >= 16 && (alignofs & 3) == 2 && bytes >= 2) - { - emit_move_insn (adjust_address (orig_dst, HImode, ofs), const0_rtx); - bytes -= 2; - ofs += 2; - alignofs -= 2; - } - if (alignofs == 4 && bytes >= 4) - { - emit_move_insn (adjust_address (orig_dst, SImode, ofs), const0_rtx); - bytes -= 4; - ofs += 4; - alignofs = 0; - } - - /* If we've not used the extra lead alignment information by now, - we won't be able to. Downgrade align to match what's left over. */ - if (alignofs > 0) - { - alignofs = alignofs & -alignofs; - align = MIN (align, alignofs * BITS_PER_UNIT); - } - } - - /* Handle a block of contiguous long-words. */ - - if (align >= 64 && bytes >= 8) - { - words = bytes / 8; - - for (i = 0; i < words; ++i) - emit_move_insn (adjust_address (orig_dst, DImode, ofs + i * 8), - const0_rtx); - - bytes -= words * 8; - ofs += words * 8; - } - - /* If the block is large and appropriately aligned, emit a single - store followed by a sequence of stq_u insns. */ - - if (align >= 32 && bytes > 16) - { - rtx orig_dsta; - - emit_move_insn (adjust_address (orig_dst, SImode, ofs), const0_rtx); - bytes -= 4; - ofs += 4; - - orig_dsta = XEXP (orig_dst, 0); - if (GET_CODE (orig_dsta) == LO_SUM) - orig_dsta = force_reg (Pmode, orig_dsta); - - words = bytes / 8; - for (i = 0; i < words; ++i) - { - rtx mem - = change_address (orig_dst, DImode, - gen_rtx_AND (DImode, - plus_constant (orig_dsta, ofs + i*8), - GEN_INT (-8))); - set_mem_alias_set (mem, 0); - emit_move_insn (mem, const0_rtx); - } - - /* Depending on the alignment, the first stq_u may have overlapped - with the initial stl, which means that the last stq_u didn't - write as much as it would appear. Leave those questionable bytes - unaccounted for. */ - bytes -= words * 8 - 4; - ofs += words * 8 - 4; - } - - /* Handle a smaller block of aligned words. */ - - if ((align >= 64 && bytes == 4) - || (align == 32 && bytes >= 4)) - { - words = bytes / 4; - - for (i = 0; i < words; ++i) - emit_move_insn (adjust_address (orig_dst, SImode, ofs + i * 4), - const0_rtx); - - bytes -= words * 4; - ofs += words * 4; - } - - /* An unaligned block uses stq_u stores for as many as possible. */ - - if (bytes >= 8) - { - words = bytes / 8; - - alpha_expand_unaligned_store_words (NULL, orig_dst, words, ofs); - - bytes -= words * 8; - ofs += words * 8; - } - - /* Next clean up any trailing pieces. */ - -#if HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT >= 64 - /* Count the number of bits in BYTES for which aligned stores could - be emitted. */ - words = 0; - for (i = (TARGET_BWX ? 1 : 4); i * BITS_PER_UNIT <= align ; i <<= 1) - if (bytes & i) - words += 1; - - /* If we have appropriate alignment (and it wouldn't take too many - instructions otherwise), mask out the bytes we need. */ - if (TARGET_BWX ? words > 2 : bytes > 0) - { - if (align >= 64) - { - rtx mem, tmp; - HOST_WIDE_INT mask; - - mem = adjust_address (orig_dst, DImode, ofs); - set_mem_alias_set (mem, 0); - - mask = ~(HOST_WIDE_INT)0 << (bytes * 8); - - tmp = expand_binop (DImode, and_optab, mem, GEN_INT (mask), - NULL_RTX, 1, OPTAB_WIDEN); - - emit_move_insn (mem, tmp); - return 1; - } - else if (align >= 32 && bytes < 4) - { - rtx mem, tmp; - HOST_WIDE_INT mask; - - mem = adjust_address (orig_dst, SImode, ofs); - set_mem_alias_set (mem, 0); - - mask = ~(HOST_WIDE_INT)0 << (bytes * 8); - - tmp = expand_binop (SImode, and_optab, mem, GEN_INT (mask), - NULL_RTX, 1, OPTAB_WIDEN); - - emit_move_insn (mem, tmp); - return 1; - } - } -#endif - - if (!TARGET_BWX && bytes >= 4) - { - alpha_expand_unaligned_store (orig_dst, const0_rtx, 4, ofs); - bytes -= 4; - ofs += 4; - } - - if (bytes >= 2) - { - if (align >= 16) - { - do { - emit_move_insn (adjust_address (orig_dst, HImode, ofs), - const0_rtx); - bytes -= 2; - ofs += 2; - } while (bytes >= 2); - } - else if (! TARGET_BWX) - { - alpha_expand_unaligned_store (orig_dst, const0_rtx, 2, ofs); - bytes -= 2; - ofs += 2; - } - } - - while (bytes > 0) - { - emit_move_insn (adjust_address (orig_dst, QImode, ofs), const0_rtx); - bytes -= 1; - ofs += 1; - } - - return 1; -} - -/* Returns a mask so that zap(x, value) == x & mask. */ - -rtx -alpha_expand_zap_mask (HOST_WIDE_INT value) -{ - rtx result; - int i; - - if (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT >= 64) - { - HOST_WIDE_INT mask = 0; - - for (i = 7; i >= 0; --i) - { - mask <<= 8; - if (!((value >> i) & 1)) - mask |= 0xff; - } - - result = gen_int_mode (mask, DImode); - } - else if (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 32) - { - HOST_WIDE_INT mask_lo = 0, mask_hi = 0; - - for (i = 7; i >= 4; --i) - { - mask_hi <<= 8; - if (!((value >> i) & 1)) - mask_hi |= 0xff; - } - - for (i = 3; i >= 0; --i) - { - mask_lo <<= 8; - if (!((value >> i) & 1)) - mask_lo |= 0xff; - } - - result = immed_double_const (mask_lo, mask_hi, DImode); - } - else - abort (); - - return result; -} - -void -alpha_expand_builtin_vector_binop (rtx (*gen) (rtx, rtx, rtx), - enum machine_mode mode, - rtx op0, rtx op1, rtx op2) -{ - op0 = gen_lowpart (mode, op0); - - if (op1 == const0_rtx) - op1 = CONST0_RTX (mode); - else - op1 = gen_lowpart (mode, op1); - - if (op2 == const0_rtx) - op2 = CONST0_RTX (mode); - else - op2 = gen_lowpart (mode, op2); - - emit_insn ((*gen) (op0, op1, op2)); -} - -/* Adjust the cost of a scheduling dependency. Return the new cost of - a dependency LINK or INSN on DEP_INSN. COST is the current cost. */ - -static int -alpha_adjust_cost (rtx insn, rtx link, rtx dep_insn, int cost) -{ - enum attr_type insn_type, dep_insn_type; - - /* If the dependence is an anti-dependence, there is no cost. For an - output dependence, there is sometimes a cost, but it doesn't seem - worth handling those few cases. */ - if (REG_NOTE_KIND (link) != 0) - return cost; - - /* If we can't recognize the insns, we can't really do anything. */ - if (recog_memoized (insn) < 0 || recog_memoized (dep_insn) < 0) - return cost; - - insn_type = get_attr_type (insn); - dep_insn_type = get_attr_type (dep_insn); - - /* Bring in the user-defined memory latency. */ - if (dep_insn_type == TYPE_ILD - || dep_insn_type == TYPE_FLD - || dep_insn_type == TYPE_LDSYM) - cost += alpha_memory_latency-1; - - /* Everything else handled in DFA bypasses now. */ - - return cost; -} - -/* The number of instructions that can be issued per cycle. */ - -static int -alpha_issue_rate (void) -{ - return (alpha_cpu == PROCESSOR_EV4 ? 2 : 4); -} - -static int -alpha_use_dfa_pipeline_interface (void) -{ - return true; -} - -/* How many alternative schedules to try. This should be as wide as the - scheduling freedom in the DFA, but no wider. Making this value too - large results extra work for the scheduler. - - For EV4, loads can be issued to either IB0 or IB1, thus we have 2 - alternative schedules. For EV5, we can choose between E0/E1 and - FA/FM. For EV6, an arithmetic insn can be issued to U0/U1/L0/L1. */ - -static int -alpha_multipass_dfa_lookahead (void) -{ - return (alpha_cpu == PROCESSOR_EV6 ? 4 : 2); -} - -/* Machine-specific function data. */ - -struct machine_function GTY(()) -{ - /* For unicosmk. */ - /* List of call information words for calls from this function. */ - struct rtx_def *first_ciw; - struct rtx_def *last_ciw; - int ciw_count; - - /* List of deferred case vectors. */ - struct rtx_def *addr_list; - - /* For OSF. */ - const char *some_ld_name; -}; - -/* How to allocate a 'struct machine_function'. */ - -static struct machine_function * -alpha_init_machine_status (void) -{ - return ((struct machine_function *) - ggc_alloc_cleared (sizeof (struct machine_function))); -} - -/* Functions to save and restore alpha_return_addr_rtx. */ - -/* Start the ball rolling with RETURN_ADDR_RTX. */ - -rtx -alpha_return_addr (int count, rtx frame ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED) -{ - if (count != 0) - return const0_rtx; - - return get_hard_reg_initial_val (Pmode, REG_RA); -} - -/* Return or create a pseudo containing the gp value for the current - function. Needed only if TARGET_LD_BUGGY_LDGP. */ - -rtx -alpha_gp_save_rtx (void) -{ - rtx r = get_hard_reg_initial_val (DImode, 29); - if (GET_CODE (r) != MEM) - r = gen_mem_addressof (r, NULL_TREE, /*rescan=*/true); - return r; -} - -static int -alpha_ra_ever_killed (void) -{ - rtx top; - - if (!has_hard_reg_initial_val (Pmode, REG_RA)) - return regs_ever_live[REG_RA]; - - push_topmost_sequence (); - top = get_insns (); - pop_topmost_sequence (); - - return reg_set_between_p (gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, REG_RA), top, NULL_RTX); -} - - -/* Return the trap mode suffix applicable to the current - instruction, or NULL. */ - -static const char * -get_trap_mode_suffix (void) -{ - enum attr_trap_suffix s = get_attr_trap_suffix (current_output_insn); - - switch (s) - { - case TRAP_SUFFIX_NONE: - return NULL; - - case TRAP_SUFFIX_SU: - if (alpha_fptm >= ALPHA_FPTM_SU) - return "su"; - return NULL; - - case TRAP_SUFFIX_SUI: - if (alpha_fptm >= ALPHA_FPTM_SUI) - return "sui"; - return NULL; - - case TRAP_SUFFIX_V_SV: - switch (alpha_fptm) - { - case ALPHA_FPTM_N: - return NULL; - case ALPHA_FPTM_U: - return "v"; - case ALPHA_FPTM_SU: - case ALPHA_FPTM_SUI: - return "sv"; - } - break; - - case TRAP_SUFFIX_V_SV_SVI: - switch (alpha_fptm) - { - case ALPHA_FPTM_N: - return NULL; - case ALPHA_FPTM_U: - return "v"; - case ALPHA_FPTM_SU: - return "sv"; - case ALPHA_FPTM_SUI: - return "svi"; - } - break; - - case TRAP_SUFFIX_U_SU_SUI: - switch (alpha_fptm) - { - case ALPHA_FPTM_N: - return NULL; - case ALPHA_FPTM_U: - return "u"; - case ALPHA_FPTM_SU: - return "su"; - case ALPHA_FPTM_SUI: - return "sui"; - } - break; - } - abort (); -} - -/* Return the rounding mode suffix applicable to the current - instruction, or NULL. */ - -static const char * -get_round_mode_suffix (void) -{ - enum attr_round_suffix s = get_attr_round_suffix (current_output_insn); - - switch (s) - { - case ROUND_SUFFIX_NONE: - return NULL; - case ROUND_SUFFIX_NORMAL: - switch (alpha_fprm) - { - case ALPHA_FPRM_NORM: - return NULL; - case ALPHA_FPRM_MINF: - return "m"; - case ALPHA_FPRM_CHOP: - return "c"; - case ALPHA_FPRM_DYN: - return "d"; - } - break; - - case ROUND_SUFFIX_C: - return "c"; - } - abort (); -} - -/* Locate some local-dynamic symbol still in use by this function - so that we can print its name in some movdi_er_tlsldm pattern. */ - -static int -get_some_local_dynamic_name_1 (rtx *px, void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED) -{ - rtx x = *px; - - if (GET_CODE (x) == SYMBOL_REF - && SYMBOL_REF_TLS_MODEL (x) == TLS_MODEL_LOCAL_DYNAMIC) - { - cfun->machine->some_ld_name = XSTR (x, 0); - return 1; - } - - return 0; -} - -static const char * -get_some_local_dynamic_name (void) -{ - rtx insn; - - if (cfun->machine->some_ld_name) - return cfun->machine->some_ld_name; - - for (insn = get_insns (); insn ; insn = NEXT_INSN (insn)) - if (INSN_P (insn) - && for_each_rtx (&PATTERN (insn), get_some_local_dynamic_name_1, 0)) - return cfun->machine->some_ld_name; - - abort (); -} - -/* Print an operand. Recognize special options, documented below. */ - -void -print_operand (FILE *file, rtx x, int code) -{ - int i; - - switch (code) - { - case '~': - /* Print the assembler name of the current function. */ - assemble_name (file, alpha_fnname); - break; - - case '&': - assemble_name (file, get_some_local_dynamic_name ()); - break; - - case '/': - { - const char *trap = get_trap_mode_suffix (); - const char *round = get_round_mode_suffix (); - - if (trap || round) - fprintf (file, (TARGET_AS_SLASH_BEFORE_SUFFIX ? "/%s%s" : "%s%s"), - (trap ? trap : ""), (round ? round : "")); - break; - } - - case ',': - /* Generates single precision instruction suffix. */ - fputc ((TARGET_FLOAT_VAX ? 'f' : 's'), file); - break; - - case '-': - /* Generates double precision instruction suffix. */ - fputc ((TARGET_FLOAT_VAX ? 'g' : 't'), file); - break; - - case '+': - /* Generates a nop after a noreturn call at the very end of the - function. */ - if (next_real_insn (current_output_insn) == 0) - fprintf (file, "\n\tnop"); - break; - - case '#': - if (alpha_this_literal_sequence_number == 0) - alpha_this_literal_sequence_number = alpha_next_sequence_number++; - fprintf (file, "%d", alpha_this_literal_sequence_number); - break; - - case '*': - if (alpha_this_gpdisp_sequence_number == 0) - alpha_this_gpdisp_sequence_number = alpha_next_sequence_number++; - fprintf (file, "%d", alpha_this_gpdisp_sequence_number); - break; - - case 'H': - if (GET_CODE (x) == HIGH) - output_addr_const (file, XEXP (x, 0)); - else - output_operand_lossage ("invalid %%H value"); - break; - - case 'J': - { - const char *lituse; - - if (GET_CODE (x) == UNSPEC && XINT (x, 1) == UNSPEC_TLSGD_CALL) - { - x = XVECEXP (x, 0, 0); - lituse = "lituse_tlsgd"; - } - else if (GET_CODE (x) == UNSPEC && XINT (x, 1) == UNSPEC_TLSLDM_CALL) - { - x = XVECEXP (x, 0, 0); - lituse = "lituse_tlsldm"; - } - else if (GET_CODE (x) == CONST_INT) - lituse = "lituse_jsr"; - else - { - output_operand_lossage ("invalid %%J value"); - break; - } - - if (x != const0_rtx) - fprintf (file, "\t\t!%s!%d", lituse, (int) INTVAL (x)); - } - break; - - case 'j': - { - const char *lituse; - -#ifdef HAVE_AS_JSRDIRECT_RELOCS - lituse = "lituse_jsrdirect"; -#else - lituse = "lituse_jsr"; -#endif - - if (INTVAL (x) == 0) - abort (); - fprintf (file, "\t\t!%s!%d", lituse, (int) INTVAL (x)); - } - break; - case 'r': - /* If this operand is the constant zero, write it as "$31". */ - if (GET_CODE (x) == REG) - fprintf (file, "%s", reg_names[REGNO (x)]); - else if (x == CONST0_RTX (GET_MODE (x))) - fprintf (file, "$31"); - else - output_operand_lossage ("invalid %%r value"); - break; - - case 'R': - /* Similar, but for floating-point. */ - if (GET_CODE (x) == REG) - fprintf (file, "%s", reg_names[REGNO (x)]); - else if (x == CONST0_RTX (GET_MODE (x))) - fprintf (file, "$f31"); - else - output_operand_lossage ("invalid %%R value"); - break; - - case 'N': - /* Write the 1's complement of a constant. */ - if (GET_CODE (x) != CONST_INT) - output_operand_lossage ("invalid %%N value"); - - fprintf (file, HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC, ~ INTVAL (x)); - break; - - case 'P': - /* Write 1 << C, for a constant C. */ - if (GET_CODE (x) != CONST_INT) - output_operand_lossage ("invalid %%P value"); - - fprintf (file, HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC, (HOST_WIDE_INT) 1 << INTVAL (x)); - break; - - case 'h': - /* Write the high-order 16 bits of a constant, sign-extended. */ - if (GET_CODE (x) != CONST_INT) - output_operand_lossage ("invalid %%h value"); - - fprintf (file, HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC, INTVAL (x) >> 16); - break; - - case 'L': - /* Write the low-order 16 bits of a constant, sign-extended. */ - if (GET_CODE (x) != CONST_INT) - output_operand_lossage ("invalid %%L value"); - - fprintf (file, HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC, - (INTVAL (x) & 0xffff) - 2 * (INTVAL (x) & 0x8000)); - break; - - case 'm': - /* Write mask for ZAP insn. */ - if (GET_CODE (x) == CONST_DOUBLE) - { - HOST_WIDE_INT mask = 0; - HOST_WIDE_INT value; - - value = CONST_DOUBLE_LOW (x); - for (i = 0; i < HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR; - i++, value >>= 8) - if (value & 0xff) - mask |= (1 << i); - - value = CONST_DOUBLE_HIGH (x); - for (i = 0; i < HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR; - i++, value >>= 8) - if (value & 0xff) - mask |= (1 << (i + sizeof (int))); - - fprintf (file, HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC, mask & 0xff); - } - - else if (GET_CODE (x) == CONST_INT) - { - HOST_WIDE_INT mask = 0, value = INTVAL (x); - - for (i = 0; i < 8; i++, value >>= 8) - if (value & 0xff) - mask |= (1 << i); - - fprintf (file, HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC, mask); - } - else - output_operand_lossage ("invalid %%m value"); - break; - - case 'M': - /* 'b', 'w', 'l', or 'q' as the value of the constant. */ - if (GET_CODE (x) != CONST_INT - || (INTVAL (x) != 8 && INTVAL (x) != 16 - && INTVAL (x) != 32 && INTVAL (x) != 64)) - output_operand_lossage ("invalid %%M value"); - - fprintf (file, "%s", - (INTVAL (x) == 8 ? "b" - : INTVAL (x) == 16 ? "w" - : INTVAL (x) == 32 ? "l" - : "q")); - break; - - case 'U': - /* Similar, except do it from the mask. */ - if (GET_CODE (x) == CONST_INT) - { - HOST_WIDE_INT value = INTVAL (x); - - if (value == 0xff) - { - fputc ('b', file); - break; - } - if (value == 0xffff) - { - fputc ('w', file); - break; - } - if (value == 0xffffffff) - { - fputc ('l', file); - break; - } - if (value == -1) - { - fputc ('q', file); - break; - } - } - else if (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 32 - && GET_CODE (x) == CONST_DOUBLE - && CONST_DOUBLE_LOW (x) == 0xffffffff - && CONST_DOUBLE_HIGH (x) == 0) - { - fputc ('l', file); - break; - } - output_operand_lossage ("invalid %%U value"); - break; - - case 's': - /* Write the constant value divided by 8 for little-endian mode or - (56 - value) / 8 for big-endian mode. */ - - if (GET_CODE (x) != CONST_INT - || (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) INTVAL (x) >= (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN - ? 56 - : 64) - || (INTVAL (x) & 7) != 0) - output_operand_lossage ("invalid %%s value"); - - fprintf (file, HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC, - WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN - ? (56 - INTVAL (x)) / 8 - : INTVAL (x) / 8); - break; - - case 'S': - /* Same, except compute (64 - c) / 8 */ - - if (GET_CODE (x) != CONST_INT - && (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) INTVAL (x) >= 64 - && (INTVAL (x) & 7) != 8) - output_operand_lossage ("invalid %%s value"); - - fprintf (file, HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC, (64 - INTVAL (x)) / 8); - break; - - case 't': - { - /* On Unicos/Mk systems: use a DEX expression if the symbol - clashes with a register name. */ - int dex = unicosmk_need_dex (x); - if (dex) - fprintf (file, "DEX(%d)", dex); - else - output_addr_const (file, x); - } - break; - - case 'C': case 'D': case 'c': case 'd': - /* Write out comparison name. */ - { - enum rtx_code c = GET_CODE (x); - - if (GET_RTX_CLASS (c) != '<') - output_operand_lossage ("invalid %%C value"); - - else if (code == 'D') - c = reverse_condition (c); - else if (code == 'c') - c = swap_condition (c); - else if (code == 'd') - c = swap_condition (reverse_condition (c)); - - if (c == LEU) - fprintf (file, "ule"); - else if (c == LTU) - fprintf (file, "ult"); - else if (c == UNORDERED) - fprintf (file, "un"); - else - fprintf (file, "%s", GET_RTX_NAME (c)); - } - break; - - case 'E': - /* Write the divide or modulus operator. */ - switch (GET_CODE (x)) - { - case DIV: - fprintf (file, "div%s", GET_MODE (x) == SImode ? "l" : "q"); - break; - case UDIV: - fprintf (file, "div%su", GET_MODE (x) == SImode ? "l" : "q"); - break; - case MOD: - fprintf (file, "rem%s", GET_MODE (x) == SImode ? "l" : "q"); - break; - case UMOD: - fprintf (file, "rem%su", GET_MODE (x) == SImode ? "l" : "q"); - break; - default: - output_operand_lossage ("invalid %%E value"); - break; - } - break; - - case 'A': - /* Write "_u" for unaligned access. */ - if (GET_CODE (x) == MEM && GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == AND) - fprintf (file, "_u"); - break; - - case 0: - if (GET_CODE (x) == REG) - fprintf (file, "%s", reg_names[REGNO (x)]); - else if (GET_CODE (x) == MEM) - output_address (XEXP (x, 0)); - else if (GET_CODE (x) == CONST && GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == UNSPEC) - { - switch (XINT (XEXP (x, 0), 1)) - { - case UNSPEC_DTPREL: - case UNSPEC_TPREL: - output_addr_const (file, XVECEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 0, 0)); - break; - default: - output_operand_lossage ("unknown relocation unspec"); - break; - } - } - else - output_addr_const (file, x); - break; - - default: - output_operand_lossage ("invalid %%xn code"); - } -} - -void -print_operand_address (FILE *file, rtx addr) -{ - int basereg = 31; - HOST_WIDE_INT offset = 0; - - if (GET_CODE (addr) == AND) - addr = XEXP (addr, 0); - - if (GET_CODE (addr) == PLUS - && GET_CODE (XEXP (addr, 1)) == CONST_INT) - { - offset = INTVAL (XEXP (addr, 1)); - addr = XEXP (addr, 0); - } - - if (GET_CODE (addr) == LO_SUM) - { - const char *reloc16, *reloclo; - rtx op1 = XEXP (addr, 1); - - if (GET_CODE (op1) == CONST && GET_CODE (XEXP (op1, 0)) == UNSPEC) - { - op1 = XEXP (op1, 0); - switch (XINT (op1, 1)) - { - case UNSPEC_DTPREL: - reloc16 = NULL; - reloclo = (alpha_tls_size == 16 ? "dtprel" : "dtprello"); - break; - case UNSPEC_TPREL: - reloc16 = NULL; - reloclo = (alpha_tls_size == 16 ? "tprel" : "tprello"); - break; - default: - output_operand_lossage ("unknown relocation unspec"); - return; - } - - output_addr_const (file, XVECEXP (op1, 0, 0)); - } - else - { - reloc16 = "gprel"; - reloclo = "gprellow"; - output_addr_const (file, op1); - } - - if (offset) - fprintf (file, "+" HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC, offset); - - addr = XEXP (addr, 0); - if (GET_CODE (addr) == REG) - basereg = REGNO (addr); - else if (GET_CODE (addr) == SUBREG - && GET_CODE (SUBREG_REG (addr)) == REG) - basereg = subreg_regno (addr); - else - abort (); - - fprintf (file, "($%d)\t\t!%s", basereg, - (basereg == 29 ? reloc16 : reloclo)); - return; - } - - if (GET_CODE (addr) == REG) - basereg = REGNO (addr); - else if (GET_CODE (addr) == SUBREG - && GET_CODE (SUBREG_REG (addr)) == REG) - basereg = subreg_regno (addr); - else if (GET_CODE (addr) == CONST_INT) - offset = INTVAL (addr); - -#if TARGET_ABI_OPEN_VMS - else if (GET_CODE (addr) == SYMBOL_REF) - { - fprintf (file, "%s", XSTR (addr, 0)); - return; - } - else if (GET_CODE (addr) == CONST - && GET_CODE (XEXP (addr, 0)) == PLUS - && GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (addr, 0), 0)) == SYMBOL_REF) - { - fprintf (file, "%s+" HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC, - XSTR (XEXP (XEXP (addr, 0), 0), 0), - INTVAL (XEXP (XEXP (addr, 0), 1))); - return; - } -#endif - - else - abort (); - - fprintf (file, HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC "($%d)", offset, basereg); -} - -/* Emit RTL insns to initialize the variable parts of a trampoline at - TRAMP. FNADDR is an RTX for the address of the function's pure - code. CXT is an RTX for the static chain value for the function. - - The three offset parameters are for the individual template's - layout. A JMPOFS < 0 indicates that the trampoline does not - contain instructions at all. - - We assume here that a function will be called many more times than - its address is taken (e.g., it might be passed to qsort), so we - take the trouble to initialize the "hint" field in the JMP insn. - Note that the hint field is PC (new) + 4 * bits 13:0. */ - -void -alpha_initialize_trampoline (rtx tramp, rtx fnaddr, rtx cxt, - int fnofs, int cxtofs, int jmpofs) -{ - rtx temp, temp1, addr; - /* VMS really uses DImode pointers in memory at this point. */ - enum machine_mode mode = TARGET_ABI_OPEN_VMS ? Pmode : ptr_mode; - -#ifdef POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED - fnaddr = convert_memory_address (mode, fnaddr); - cxt = convert_memory_address (mode, cxt); -#endif - - /* Store function address and CXT. */ - addr = memory_address (mode, plus_constant (tramp, fnofs)); - emit_move_insn (gen_rtx_MEM (mode, addr), fnaddr); - addr = memory_address (mode, plus_constant (tramp, cxtofs)); - emit_move_insn (gen_rtx_MEM (mode, addr), cxt); - - /* This has been disabled since the hint only has a 32k range, and in - no existing OS is the stack within 32k of the text segment. */ - if (0 && jmpofs >= 0) - { - /* Compute hint value. */ - temp = force_operand (plus_constant (tramp, jmpofs+4), NULL_RTX); - temp = expand_binop (DImode, sub_optab, fnaddr, temp, temp, 1, - OPTAB_WIDEN); - temp = expand_shift (RSHIFT_EXPR, Pmode, temp, - build_int_2 (2, 0), NULL_RTX, 1); - temp = expand_and (SImode, gen_lowpart (SImode, temp), - GEN_INT (0x3fff), 0); - - /* Merge in the hint. */ - addr = memory_address (SImode, plus_constant (tramp, jmpofs)); - temp1 = force_reg (SImode, gen_rtx_MEM (SImode, addr)); - temp1 = expand_and (SImode, temp1, GEN_INT (0xffffc000), NULL_RTX); - temp1 = expand_binop (SImode, ior_optab, temp1, temp, temp1, 1, - OPTAB_WIDEN); - emit_move_insn (gen_rtx_MEM (SImode, addr), temp1); - } - -#ifdef ENABLE_EXECUTE_STACK - emit_library_call (init_one_libfunc ("__enable_execute_stack"), - 0, VOIDmode, 1, tramp, Pmode); -#endif - - if (jmpofs >= 0) - emit_insn (gen_imb ()); -} - -/* Determine where to put an argument to a function. - Value is zero to push the argument on the stack, - or a hard register in which to store the argument. - - MODE is the argument's machine mode. - TYPE is the data type of the argument (as a tree). - This is null for libcalls where that information may - not be available. - CUM is a variable of type CUMULATIVE_ARGS which gives info about - the preceding args and about the function being called. - NAMED is nonzero if this argument is a named parameter - (otherwise it is an extra parameter matching an ellipsis). - - On Alpha the first 6 words of args are normally in registers - and the rest are pushed. */ - -rtx -function_arg (CUMULATIVE_ARGS cum, enum machine_mode mode, tree type, - int named ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED) -{ - int basereg; - int num_args; - - /* Don't get confused and pass small structures in FP registers. */ - if (type && AGGREGATE_TYPE_P (type)) - basereg = 16; - else - { -#ifdef ENABLE_CHECKING - /* With alpha_split_complex_arg, we shouldn't see any raw complex - values here. */ - if (COMPLEX_MODE_P (mode)) - abort (); -#endif - - /* Set up defaults for FP operands passed in FP registers, and - integral operands passed in integer registers. */ - if (TARGET_FPREGS && GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_FLOAT) - basereg = 32 + 16; - else - basereg = 16; - } - - /* ??? Irritatingly, the definition of CUMULATIVE_ARGS is different for - the three platforms, so we can't avoid conditional compilation. */ -#if TARGET_ABI_OPEN_VMS - { - if (mode == VOIDmode) - return alpha_arg_info_reg_val (cum); - - num_args = cum.num_args; - if (num_args >= 6 || MUST_PASS_IN_STACK (mode, type)) - return NULL_RTX; - } -#elif TARGET_ABI_UNICOSMK - { - int size; - - /* If this is the last argument, generate the call info word (CIW). */ - /* ??? We don't include the caller's line number in the CIW because - I don't know how to determine it if debug infos are turned off. */ - if (mode == VOIDmode) - { - int i; - HOST_WIDE_INT lo; - HOST_WIDE_INT hi; - rtx ciw; - - lo = 0; - - for (i = 0; i < cum.num_reg_words && i < 5; i++) - if (cum.reg_args_type[i]) - lo |= (1 << (7 - i)); - - if (cum.num_reg_words == 6 && cum.reg_args_type[5]) - lo |= 7; - else - lo |= cum.num_reg_words; - -#if HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 32 - hi = (cum.num_args << 20) | cum.num_arg_words; -#else - lo = lo | ((HOST_WIDE_INT) cum.num_args << 52) - | ((HOST_WIDE_INT) cum.num_arg_words << 32); - hi = 0; -#endif - ciw = immed_double_const (lo, hi, DImode); - - return gen_rtx_UNSPEC (DImode, gen_rtvec (1, ciw), - UNSPEC_UMK_LOAD_CIW); - } - - size = ALPHA_ARG_SIZE (mode, type, named); - num_args = cum.num_reg_words; - if (MUST_PASS_IN_STACK (mode, type) - || cum.num_reg_words + size > 6 || cum.force_stack) - return NULL_RTX; - else if (type && TYPE_MODE (type) == BLKmode) - { - rtx reg1, reg2; - - reg1 = gen_rtx_REG (DImode, num_args + 16); - reg1 = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (DImode, reg1, const0_rtx); - - /* The argument fits in two registers. Note that we still need to - reserve a register for empty structures. */ - if (size == 0) - return NULL_RTX; - else if (size == 1) - return gen_rtx_PARALLEL (mode, gen_rtvec (1, reg1)); - else - { - reg2 = gen_rtx_REG (DImode, num_args + 17); - reg2 = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (DImode, reg2, GEN_INT (8)); - return gen_rtx_PARALLEL (mode, gen_rtvec (2, reg1, reg2)); - } - } - } -#elif TARGET_ABI_OSF - { - if (cum >= 6) - return NULL_RTX; - num_args = cum; - - /* VOID is passed as a special flag for "last argument". */ - if (type == void_type_node) - basereg = 16; - else if (MUST_PASS_IN_STACK (mode, type)) - return NULL_RTX; - else if (FUNCTION_ARG_PASS_BY_REFERENCE (cum, mode, type, named)) - basereg = 16; - } -#else -#error Unhandled ABI -#endif - - return gen_rtx_REG (mode, num_args + basereg); -} - -/* Return true if TYPE must be returned in memory, instead of in registers. */ - -static bool -alpha_return_in_memory (tree type, tree fndecl ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED) -{ - enum machine_mode mode = VOIDmode; - int size; - - if (type) - { - mode = TYPE_MODE (type); - - /* All aggregates are returned in memory. */ - if (AGGREGATE_TYPE_P (type)) - return true; - } - - size = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode); - switch (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode)) - { - case MODE_VECTOR_FLOAT: - /* Pass all float vectors in memory, like an aggregate. */ - return true; - - case MODE_COMPLEX_FLOAT: - /* We judge complex floats on the size of their element, - not the size of the whole type. */ - size = GET_MODE_UNIT_SIZE (mode); - break; - - case MODE_INT: - case MODE_FLOAT: - case MODE_COMPLEX_INT: - case MODE_VECTOR_INT: - break; - - default: - /* ??? We get called on all sorts of random stuff from - aggregate_value_p. We can't abort, but it's not clear - what's safe to return. Pretend it's a struct I guess. */ - return true; - } - - /* Otherwise types must fit in one register. */ - return size > UNITS_PER_WORD; -} - -/* Define how to find the value returned by a function. VALTYPE is the - data type of the value (as a tree). If the precise function being - called is known, FUNC is its FUNCTION_DECL; otherwise, FUNC is 0. - MODE is set instead of VALTYPE for libcalls. - - On Alpha the value is found in $0 for integer functions and - $f0 for floating-point functions. */ - -rtx -function_value (tree valtype, tree func ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, - enum machine_mode mode) -{ - unsigned int regnum; - enum mode_class class; - -#ifdef ENABLE_CHECKING - if (valtype && alpha_return_in_memory (valtype, func)) - abort (); -#endif - - if (valtype) - mode = TYPE_MODE (valtype); - - class = GET_MODE_CLASS (mode); - switch (class) - { - case MODE_INT: - /* Do the same thing as PROMOTE_MODE. */ - mode = DImode; - /* FALLTHRU */ - - case MODE_COMPLEX_INT: - case MODE_VECTOR_INT: - regnum = 0; - break; - - case MODE_FLOAT: - regnum = 32; - break; - - case MODE_COMPLEX_FLOAT: - { - enum machine_mode cmode = GET_MODE_INNER (mode); - - return gen_rtx_PARALLEL - (VOIDmode, - gen_rtvec (2, - gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (VOIDmode, gen_rtx_REG (cmode, 32), - GEN_INT (0)), - gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (VOIDmode, gen_rtx_REG (cmode, 33), - GEN_INT (GET_MODE_SIZE (cmode))))); - } - - default: - abort (); - } - - return gen_rtx_REG (mode, regnum); -} - -/* TCmode complex values are passed by invisible reference. We - should not split these values. */ - -static bool -alpha_split_complex_arg (tree type) -{ - return TYPE_MODE (type) != TCmode; -} - -static tree -alpha_build_builtin_va_list (void) -{ - tree base, ofs, space, record, type_decl; - - if (TARGET_ABI_OPEN_VMS || TARGET_ABI_UNICOSMK) - return ptr_type_node; - - record = (*lang_hooks.types.make_type) (RECORD_TYPE); - type_decl = build_decl (TYPE_DECL, get_identifier ("__va_list_tag"), record); - TREE_CHAIN (record) = type_decl; - TYPE_NAME (record) = type_decl; - - /* C++? SET_IS_AGGR_TYPE (record, 1); */ - - /* Dummy field to prevent alignment warnings. */ - space = build_decl (FIELD_DECL, NULL_TREE, integer_type_node); - DECL_FIELD_CONTEXT (space) = record; - DECL_ARTIFICIAL (space) = 1; - DECL_IGNORED_P (space) = 1; - - ofs = build_decl (FIELD_DECL, get_identifier ("__offset"), - integer_type_node); - DECL_FIELD_CONTEXT (ofs) = record; - TREE_CHAIN (ofs) = space; - - base = build_decl (FIELD_DECL, get_identifier ("__base"), - ptr_type_node); - DECL_FIELD_CONTEXT (base) = record; - TREE_CHAIN (base) = ofs; - - TYPE_FIELDS (record) = base; - layout_type (record); - - return record; -} - -/* Perform any needed actions needed for a function that is receiving a - variable number of arguments. */ - -static void -alpha_setup_incoming_varargs (CUMULATIVE_ARGS *pcum, - enum machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, - tree type ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, - int *pretend_size, int no_rtl) -{ -#if TARGET_ABI_UNICOSMK - /* On Unicos/Mk, the standard subroutine __T3E_MISMATCH stores all register - arguments on the stack. Unfortunately, it doesn't always store the first - one (i.e. the one that arrives in $16 or $f16). This is not a problem - with stdargs as we always have at least one named argument there. */ - int num_reg_words = pcum->num_reg_words; - if (num_reg_words < 6) - { - if (!no_rtl) - { - emit_insn (gen_umk_mismatch_args (GEN_INT (num_reg_words + 1))); - emit_insn (gen_arg_home_umk ()); - } - *pretend_size = 0; - } -#elif TARGET_ABI_OPEN_VMS - /* For VMS, we allocate space for all 6 arg registers plus a count. - - However, if NO registers need to be saved, don't allocate any space. - This is not only because we won't need the space, but because AP - includes the current_pretend_args_size and we don't want to mess up - any ap-relative addresses already made. */ - if (pcum->num_args < 6) - { - if (!no_rtl) - { - emit_move_insn (gen_rtx_REG (DImode, 1), virtual_incoming_args_rtx); - emit_insn (gen_arg_home ()); - } - *pretend_size = 7 * UNITS_PER_WORD; - } -#else - /* On OSF/1 and friends, we allocate space for all 12 arg registers, but - only push those that are remaining. However, if NO registers need to - be saved, don't allocate any space. This is not only because we won't - need the space, but because AP includes the current_pretend_args_size - and we don't want to mess up any ap-relative addresses already made. - - If we are not to use the floating-point registers, save the integer - registers where we would put the floating-point registers. This is - not the most efficient way to implement varargs with just one register - class, but it isn't worth doing anything more efficient in this rare - case. */ - CUMULATIVE_ARGS cum = *pcum; - - if (cum >= 6) - return; - - if (!no_rtl) - { - int set = get_varargs_alias_set (); - rtx tmp; - - tmp = gen_rtx_MEM (BLKmode, - plus_constant (virtual_incoming_args_rtx, - (cum + 6) * UNITS_PER_WORD)); - set_mem_alias_set (tmp, set); - move_block_from_reg (16 + cum, tmp, 6 - cum); - - tmp = gen_rtx_MEM (BLKmode, - plus_constant (virtual_incoming_args_rtx, - cum * UNITS_PER_WORD)); - set_mem_alias_set (tmp, set); - move_block_from_reg (16 + (TARGET_FPREGS ? 32 : 0) + cum, tmp, - 6 - cum); - } - *pretend_size = 12 * UNITS_PER_WORD; -#endif -} - -void -alpha_va_start (tree valist, rtx nextarg ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED) -{ - HOST_WIDE_INT offset; - tree t, offset_field, base_field; - - if (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (valist)) == ERROR_MARK) - return; - - if (TARGET_ABI_UNICOSMK) - std_expand_builtin_va_start (valist, nextarg); - - /* For Unix, SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS moves the starting address base - up by 48, storing fp arg registers in the first 48 bytes, and the - integer arg registers in the next 48 bytes. This is only done, - however, if any integer registers need to be stored. - - If no integer registers need be stored, then we must subtract 48 - in order to account for the integer arg registers which are counted - in argsize above, but which are not actually stored on the stack. - Must further be careful here about structures straddling the last - integer argument register; that futzes with pretend_args_size, - which changes the meaning of AP. */ - - if (NUM_ARGS <= 6) - offset = TARGET_ABI_OPEN_VMS ? UNITS_PER_WORD : 6 * UNITS_PER_WORD; - else - offset = -6 * UNITS_PER_WORD + current_function_pretend_args_size; - - if (TARGET_ABI_OPEN_VMS) - { - nextarg = plus_constant (nextarg, offset); - nextarg = plus_constant (nextarg, NUM_ARGS * UNITS_PER_WORD); - t = build (MODIFY_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (valist), valist, - make_tree (ptr_type_node, nextarg)); - TREE_SIDE_EFFECTS (t) = 1; - - expand_expr (t, const0_rtx, VOIDmode, EXPAND_NORMAL); - } - else - { - base_field = TYPE_FIELDS (TREE_TYPE (valist)); - offset_field = TREE_CHAIN (base_field); - - base_field = build (COMPONENT_REF, TREE_TYPE (base_field), - valist, base_field); - offset_field = build (COMPONENT_REF, TREE_TYPE (offset_field), - valist, offset_field); - - t = make_tree (ptr_type_node, virtual_incoming_args_rtx); - t = build (PLUS_EXPR, ptr_type_node, t, build_int_2 (offset, 0)); - t = build (MODIFY_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (base_field), base_field, t); - TREE_SIDE_EFFECTS (t) = 1; - expand_expr (t, const0_rtx, VOIDmode, EXPAND_NORMAL); - - t = build_int_2 (NUM_ARGS * UNITS_PER_WORD, 0); - t = build (MODIFY_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (offset_field), offset_field, t); - TREE_SIDE_EFFECTS (t) = 1; - expand_expr (t, const0_rtx, VOIDmode, EXPAND_NORMAL); - } -} - -rtx -alpha_va_arg (tree valist, tree type) -{ - rtx addr; - tree t, type_size, rounded_size; - tree offset_field, base_field, addr_tree, addend; - tree wide_type, wide_ofs; - int indirect = 0; - - if (TARGET_ABI_OPEN_VMS || TARGET_ABI_UNICOSMK) - return std_expand_builtin_va_arg (valist, type); - - if (type == error_mark_node - || (type_size = TYPE_SIZE_UNIT (TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type))) == NULL - || TREE_OVERFLOW (type_size)) - rounded_size = size_zero_node; - else - rounded_size = fold (build (MULT_EXPR, sizetype, - fold (build (TRUNC_DIV_EXPR, sizetype, - fold (build (PLUS_EXPR, sizetype, - type_size, - size_int (7))), - size_int (8))), - size_int (8))); - - base_field = TYPE_FIELDS (TREE_TYPE (valist)); - offset_field = TREE_CHAIN (base_field); - - base_field = build (COMPONENT_REF, TREE_TYPE (base_field), - valist, base_field); - offset_field = build (COMPONENT_REF, TREE_TYPE (offset_field), - valist, offset_field); - - /* If the type could not be passed in registers, skip the block - reserved for the registers. */ - if (MUST_PASS_IN_STACK (TYPE_MODE (type), type)) - { - t = build (MODIFY_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (offset_field), offset_field, - build (MAX_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (offset_field), - offset_field, build_int_2 (6*8, 0))); - TREE_SIDE_EFFECTS (t) = 1; - expand_expr (t, const0_rtx, VOIDmode, EXPAND_NORMAL); - } - - wide_type = make_signed_type (64); - wide_ofs = save_expr (build1 (CONVERT_EXPR, wide_type, offset_field)); - - addend = wide_ofs; - - if (TYPE_MODE (type) == TFmode || TYPE_MODE (type) == TCmode) - { - indirect = 1; - rounded_size = size_int (UNITS_PER_WORD); - } - else if (TREE_CODE (type) == COMPLEX_TYPE) - { - rtx real_part, imag_part, value, tmp; - - real_part = alpha_va_arg (valist, TREE_TYPE (type)); - imag_part = alpha_va_arg (valist, TREE_TYPE (type)); - - /* ??? Most irritatingly, we're not returning the value here, - but the address. Since real_part and imag_part are not - necessarily contiguous, we must copy to local storage. */ - - real_part = gen_rtx_MEM (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (type)), real_part); - imag_part = gen_rtx_MEM (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (type)), imag_part); - value = gen_rtx_CONCAT (TYPE_MODE (type), real_part, imag_part); - - tmp = assign_temp (type, 0, 1, 0); - emit_move_insn (tmp, value); - - return XEXP (tmp, 0); - } - else if (TREE_CODE (type) == REAL_TYPE) - { - tree fpaddend, cond; - - fpaddend = fold (build (PLUS_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (addend), - addend, build_int_2 (-6*8, 0))); - - cond = fold (build (LT_EXPR, integer_type_node, - wide_ofs, build_int_2 (6*8, 0))); - - addend = fold (build (COND_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (addend), cond, - fpaddend, addend)); - } - - addr_tree = build (PLUS_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (base_field), - base_field, addend); - - addr = expand_expr (addr_tree, NULL_RTX, Pmode, EXPAND_NORMAL); - addr = copy_to_reg (addr); - - t = build (MODIFY_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (offset_field), offset_field, - build (PLUS_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (offset_field), - offset_field, rounded_size)); - TREE_SIDE_EFFECTS (t) = 1; - expand_expr (t, const0_rtx, VOIDmode, EXPAND_NORMAL); - - if (indirect) - { - addr = force_reg (Pmode, addr); - addr = gen_rtx_MEM (Pmode, addr); - } - - return addr; -} - -/* Builtins. */ - -enum alpha_builtin -{ - ALPHA_BUILTIN_CMPBGE, - ALPHA_BUILTIN_EXTBL, - ALPHA_BUILTIN_EXTWL, - ALPHA_BUILTIN_EXTLL, - ALPHA_BUILTIN_EXTQL, - ALPHA_BUILTIN_EXTWH, - ALPHA_BUILTIN_EXTLH, - ALPHA_BUILTIN_EXTQH, - ALPHA_BUILTIN_INSBL, - ALPHA_BUILTIN_INSWL, - ALPHA_BUILTIN_INSLL, - ALPHA_BUILTIN_INSQL, - ALPHA_BUILTIN_INSWH, - ALPHA_BUILTIN_INSLH, - ALPHA_BUILTIN_INSQH, - ALPHA_BUILTIN_MSKBL, - ALPHA_BUILTIN_MSKWL, - ALPHA_BUILTIN_MSKLL, - ALPHA_BUILTIN_MSKQL, - ALPHA_BUILTIN_MSKWH, - ALPHA_BUILTIN_MSKLH, - ALPHA_BUILTIN_MSKQH, - ALPHA_BUILTIN_UMULH, - ALPHA_BUILTIN_ZAP, - ALPHA_BUILTIN_ZAPNOT, - ALPHA_BUILTIN_AMASK, - ALPHA_BUILTIN_IMPLVER, - ALPHA_BUILTIN_RPCC, - ALPHA_BUILTIN_THREAD_POINTER, - ALPHA_BUILTIN_SET_THREAD_POINTER, - - /* TARGET_MAX */ - ALPHA_BUILTIN_MINUB8, - ALPHA_BUILTIN_MINSB8, - ALPHA_BUILTIN_MINUW4, - ALPHA_BUILTIN_MINSW4, - ALPHA_BUILTIN_MAXUB8, - ALPHA_BUILTIN_MAXSB8, - ALPHA_BUILTIN_MAXUW4, - ALPHA_BUILTIN_MAXSW4, - ALPHA_BUILTIN_PERR, - ALPHA_BUILTIN_PKLB, - ALPHA_BUILTIN_PKWB, - ALPHA_BUILTIN_UNPKBL, - ALPHA_BUILTIN_UNPKBW, - - /* TARGET_CIX */ - ALPHA_BUILTIN_CTTZ, - ALPHA_BUILTIN_CTLZ, - ALPHA_BUILTIN_CTPOP, - - ALPHA_BUILTIN_max -}; - -static unsigned int const code_for_builtin[ALPHA_BUILTIN_max] = { - CODE_FOR_builtin_cmpbge, - CODE_FOR_builtin_extbl, - CODE_FOR_builtin_extwl, - CODE_FOR_builtin_extll, - CODE_FOR_builtin_extql, - CODE_FOR_builtin_extwh, - CODE_FOR_builtin_extlh, - CODE_FOR_builtin_extqh, - CODE_FOR_builtin_insbl, - CODE_FOR_builtin_inswl, - CODE_FOR_builtin_insll, - CODE_FOR_builtin_insql, - CODE_FOR_builtin_inswh, - CODE_FOR_builtin_inslh, - CODE_FOR_builtin_insqh, - CODE_FOR_builtin_mskbl, - CODE_FOR_builtin_mskwl, - CODE_FOR_builtin_mskll, - CODE_FOR_builtin_mskql, - CODE_FOR_builtin_mskwh, - CODE_FOR_builtin_msklh, - CODE_FOR_builtin_mskqh, - CODE_FOR_umuldi3_highpart, - CODE_FOR_builtin_zap, - CODE_FOR_builtin_zapnot, - CODE_FOR_builtin_amask, - CODE_FOR_builtin_implver, - CODE_FOR_builtin_rpcc, - CODE_FOR_load_tp, - CODE_FOR_set_tp, - - /* TARGET_MAX */ - CODE_FOR_builtin_minub8, - CODE_FOR_builtin_minsb8, - CODE_FOR_builtin_minuw4, - CODE_FOR_builtin_minsw4, - CODE_FOR_builtin_maxub8, - CODE_FOR_builtin_maxsb8, - CODE_FOR_builtin_maxuw4, - CODE_FOR_builtin_maxsw4, - CODE_FOR_builtin_perr, - CODE_FOR_builtin_pklb, - CODE_FOR_builtin_pkwb, - CODE_FOR_builtin_unpkbl, - CODE_FOR_builtin_unpkbw, - - /* TARGET_CIX */ - CODE_FOR_builtin_cttz, - CODE_FOR_builtin_ctlz, - CODE_FOR_builtin_ctpop -}; - -struct alpha_builtin_def -{ - const char *name; - enum alpha_builtin code; - unsigned int target_mask; -}; - -static struct alpha_builtin_def const zero_arg_builtins[] = { - { "__builtin_alpha_implver", ALPHA_BUILTIN_IMPLVER, 0 }, - { "__builtin_alpha_rpcc", ALPHA_BUILTIN_RPCC, 0 } -}; - -static struct alpha_builtin_def const one_arg_builtins[] = { - { "__builtin_alpha_amask", ALPHA_BUILTIN_AMASK, 0 }, - { "__builtin_alpha_pklb", ALPHA_BUILTIN_PKLB, MASK_MAX }, - { "__builtin_alpha_pkwb", ALPHA_BUILTIN_PKWB, MASK_MAX }, - { "__builtin_alpha_unpkbl", ALPHA_BUILTIN_UNPKBL, MASK_MAX }, - { "__builtin_alpha_unpkbw", ALPHA_BUILTIN_UNPKBW, MASK_MAX }, - { "__builtin_alpha_cttz", ALPHA_BUILTIN_CTTZ, MASK_CIX }, - { "__builtin_alpha_ctlz", ALPHA_BUILTIN_CTLZ, MASK_CIX }, - { "__builtin_alpha_ctpop", ALPHA_BUILTIN_CTPOP, MASK_CIX } -}; - -static struct alpha_builtin_def const two_arg_builtins[] = { - { "__builtin_alpha_cmpbge", ALPHA_BUILTIN_CMPBGE, 0 }, - { "__builtin_alpha_extbl", ALPHA_BUILTIN_EXTBL, 0 }, - { "__builtin_alpha_extwl", ALPHA_BUILTIN_EXTWL, 0 }, - { "__builtin_alpha_extll", ALPHA_BUILTIN_EXTLL, 0 }, - { "__builtin_alpha_extql", ALPHA_BUILTIN_EXTQL, 0 }, - { "__builtin_alpha_extwh", ALPHA_BUILTIN_EXTWH, 0 }, - { "__builtin_alpha_extlh", ALPHA_BUILTIN_EXTLH, 0 }, - { "__builtin_alpha_extqh", ALPHA_BUILTIN_EXTQH, 0 }, - { "__builtin_alpha_insbl", ALPHA_BUILTIN_INSBL, 0 }, - { "__builtin_alpha_inswl", ALPHA_BUILTIN_INSWL, 0 }, - { "__builtin_alpha_insll", ALPHA_BUILTIN_INSLL, 0 }, - { "__builtin_alpha_insql", ALPHA_BUILTIN_INSQL, 0 }, - { "__builtin_alpha_inswh", ALPHA_BUILTIN_INSWH, 0 }, - { "__builtin_alpha_inslh", ALPHA_BUILTIN_INSLH, 0 }, - { "__builtin_alpha_insqh", ALPHA_BUILTIN_INSQH, 0 }, - { "__builtin_alpha_mskbl", ALPHA_BUILTIN_MSKBL, 0 }, - { "__builtin_alpha_mskwl", ALPHA_BUILTIN_MSKWL, 0 }, - { "__builtin_alpha_mskll", ALPHA_BUILTIN_MSKLL, 0 }, - { "__builtin_alpha_mskql", ALPHA_BUILTIN_MSKQL, 0 }, - { "__builtin_alpha_mskwh", ALPHA_BUILTIN_MSKWH, 0 }, - { "__builtin_alpha_msklh", ALPHA_BUILTIN_MSKLH, 0 }, - { "__builtin_alpha_mskqh", ALPHA_BUILTIN_MSKQH, 0 }, - { "__builtin_alpha_umulh", ALPHA_BUILTIN_UMULH, 0 }, - { "__builtin_alpha_zap", ALPHA_BUILTIN_ZAP, 0 }, - { "__builtin_alpha_zapnot", ALPHA_BUILTIN_ZAPNOT, 0 }, - { "__builtin_alpha_minub8", ALPHA_BUILTIN_MINUB8, MASK_MAX }, - { "__builtin_alpha_minsb8", ALPHA_BUILTIN_MINSB8, MASK_MAX }, - { "__builtin_alpha_minuw4", ALPHA_BUILTIN_MINUW4, MASK_MAX }, - { "__builtin_alpha_minsw4", ALPHA_BUILTIN_MINSW4, MASK_MAX }, - { "__builtin_alpha_maxub8", ALPHA_BUILTIN_MAXUB8, MASK_MAX }, - { "__builtin_alpha_maxsb8", ALPHA_BUILTIN_MAXSB8, MASK_MAX }, - { "__builtin_alpha_maxuw4", ALPHA_BUILTIN_MAXUW4, MASK_MAX }, - { "__builtin_alpha_maxsw4", ALPHA_BUILTIN_MAXSW4, MASK_MAX }, - { "__builtin_alpha_perr", ALPHA_BUILTIN_PERR, MASK_MAX } -}; - -static void -alpha_init_builtins (void) -{ - const struct alpha_builtin_def *p; - tree ftype; - size_t i; - - ftype = build_function_type (long_integer_type_node, void_list_node); - - p = zero_arg_builtins; - for (i = 0; i < ARRAY_SIZE (zero_arg_builtins); ++i, ++p) - if ((target_flags & p->target_mask) == p->target_mask) - builtin_function (p->name, ftype, p->code, BUILT_IN_MD, - NULL, NULL_TREE); - - ftype = build_function_type_list (long_integer_type_node, - long_integer_type_node, NULL_TREE); - - p = one_arg_builtins; - for (i = 0; i < ARRAY_SIZE (one_arg_builtins); ++i, ++p) - if ((target_flags & p->target_mask) == p->target_mask) - builtin_function (p->name, ftype, p->code, BUILT_IN_MD, - NULL, NULL_TREE); - - ftype = build_function_type_list (long_integer_type_node, - long_integer_type_node, - long_integer_type_node, NULL_TREE); - - p = two_arg_builtins; - for (i = 0; i < ARRAY_SIZE (two_arg_builtins); ++i, ++p) - if ((target_flags & p->target_mask) == p->target_mask) - builtin_function (p->name, ftype, p->code, BUILT_IN_MD, - NULL, NULL_TREE); - - ftype = build_function_type (ptr_type_node, void_list_node); - builtin_function ("__builtin_thread_pointer", ftype, - ALPHA_BUILTIN_THREAD_POINTER, BUILT_IN_MD, - NULL, NULL_TREE); - - ftype = build_function_type_list (void_type_node, ptr_type_node, NULL_TREE); - builtin_function ("__builtin_set_thread_pointer", ftype, - ALPHA_BUILTIN_SET_THREAD_POINTER, BUILT_IN_MD, - NULL, NULL_TREE); -} - -/* Expand an expression EXP that calls a built-in function, - with result going to TARGET if that's convenient - (and in mode MODE if that's convenient). - SUBTARGET may be used as the target for computing one of EXP's operands. - IGNORE is nonzero if the value is to be ignored. */ - -static rtx -alpha_expand_builtin (tree exp, rtx target, - rtx subtarget ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, - enum machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, - int ignore ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED) -{ -#define MAX_ARGS 2 - - tree fndecl = TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0); - unsigned int fcode = DECL_FUNCTION_CODE (fndecl); - tree arglist = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1); - enum insn_code icode; - rtx op[MAX_ARGS], pat; - int arity; - bool nonvoid; - - if (fcode >= ALPHA_BUILTIN_max) - internal_error ("bad builtin fcode"); - icode = code_for_builtin[fcode]; - if (icode == 0) - internal_error ("bad builtin fcode"); - - nonvoid = TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (fndecl)) != void_type_node; - - for (arglist = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), arity = 0; - arglist; - arglist = TREE_CHAIN (arglist), arity++) - { - const struct insn_operand_data *insn_op; - - tree arg = TREE_VALUE (arglist); - if (arg == error_mark_node) - return NULL_RTX; - if (arity > MAX_ARGS) - return NULL_RTX; - - insn_op = &insn_data[icode].operand[arity + nonvoid]; - - op[arity] = expand_expr (arg, NULL_RTX, insn_op->mode, 0); - - if (!(*insn_op->predicate) (op[arity], insn_op->mode)) - op[arity] = copy_to_mode_reg (insn_op->mode, op[arity]); - } - - if (nonvoid) - { - enum machine_mode tmode = insn_data[icode].operand[0].mode; - if (!target - || GET_MODE (target) != tmode - || !(*insn_data[icode].operand[0].predicate) (target, tmode)) - target = gen_reg_rtx (tmode); - } - - switch (arity) - { - case 0: - pat = GEN_FCN (icode) (target); - break; - case 1: - if (nonvoid) - pat = GEN_FCN (icode) (target, op[0]); - else - pat = GEN_FCN (icode) (op[0]); - break; - case 2: - pat = GEN_FCN (icode) (target, op[0], op[1]); - break; - default: - abort (); - } - if (!pat) - return NULL_RTX; - emit_insn (pat); - - if (nonvoid) - return target; - else - return const0_rtx; -} - -/* This page contains routines that are used to determine what the function - prologue and epilogue code will do and write them out. */ - -/* Compute the size of the save area in the stack. */ - -/* These variables are used for communication between the following functions. - They indicate various things about the current function being compiled - that are used to tell what kind of prologue, epilogue and procedure - descriptor to generate. */ - -/* Nonzero if we need a stack procedure. */ -enum alpha_procedure_types {PT_NULL = 0, PT_REGISTER = 1, PT_STACK = 2}; -static enum alpha_procedure_types alpha_procedure_type; - -/* Register number (either FP or SP) that is used to unwind the frame. */ -static int vms_unwind_regno; - -/* Register number used to save FP. We need not have one for RA since - we don't modify it for register procedures. This is only defined - for register frame procedures. */ -static int vms_save_fp_regno; - -/* Register number used to reference objects off our PV. */ -static int vms_base_regno; - -/* Compute register masks for saved registers. */ - -static void -alpha_sa_mask (unsigned long *imaskP, unsigned long *fmaskP) -{ - unsigned long imask = 0; - unsigned long fmask = 0; - unsigned int i; - - /* When outputting a thunk, we don't have valid register life info, - but assemble_start_function wants to output .frame and .mask - directives. */ - if (current_function_is_thunk) - { - *imaskP = 0; - *fmaskP = 0; - return; - } - - if (TARGET_ABI_OPEN_VMS && alpha_procedure_type == PT_STACK) - imask |= (1UL << HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM); - - /* One for every register we have to save. */ - for (i = 0; i < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i++) - if (! fixed_regs[i] && ! call_used_regs[i] - && regs_ever_live[i] && i != REG_RA - && (!TARGET_ABI_UNICOSMK || i != HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM)) - { - if (i < 32) - imask |= (1UL << i); - else - fmask |= (1UL << (i - 32)); - } - - /* We need to restore these for the handler. */ - if (current_function_calls_eh_return) - { - for (i = 0; ; ++i) - { - unsigned regno = EH_RETURN_DATA_REGNO (i); - if (regno == INVALID_REGNUM) - break; - imask |= 1UL << regno; - } - } - - /* If any register spilled, then spill the return address also. */ - /* ??? This is required by the Digital stack unwind specification - and isn't needed if we're doing Dwarf2 unwinding. */ - if (imask || fmask || alpha_ra_ever_killed ()) - imask |= (1UL << REG_RA); - - *imaskP = imask; - *fmaskP = fmask; -} - -int -alpha_sa_size (void) -{ - unsigned long mask[2]; - int sa_size = 0; - int i, j; - - alpha_sa_mask (&mask[0], &mask[1]); - - if (TARGET_ABI_UNICOSMK) - { - if (mask[0] || mask[1]) - sa_size = 14; - } - else - { - for (j = 0; j < 2; ++j) - for (i = 0; i < 32; ++i) - if ((mask[j] >> i) & 1) - sa_size++; - } - - if (TARGET_ABI_UNICOSMK) - { - /* We might not need to generate a frame if we don't make any calls - (including calls to __T3E_MISMATCH if this is a vararg function), - don't have any local variables which require stack slots, don't - use alloca and have not determined that we need a frame for other - reasons. */ - - alpha_procedure_type - = (sa_size || get_frame_size() != 0 - || current_function_outgoing_args_size - || current_function_stdarg || current_function_calls_alloca - || frame_pointer_needed) - ? PT_STACK : PT_REGISTER; - - /* Always reserve space for saving callee-saved registers if we - need a frame as required by the calling convention. */ - if (alpha_procedure_type == PT_STACK) - sa_size = 14; - } - else if (TARGET_ABI_OPEN_VMS) - { - /* Start by assuming we can use a register procedure if we don't - make any calls (REG_RA not used) or need to save any - registers and a stack procedure if we do. */ - if ((mask[0] >> REG_RA) & 1) - alpha_procedure_type = PT_STACK; - else if (get_frame_size() != 0) - alpha_procedure_type = PT_REGISTER; - else - alpha_procedure_type = PT_NULL; - - /* Don't reserve space for saving FP & RA yet. Do that later after we've - made the final decision on stack procedure vs register procedure. */ - if (alpha_procedure_type == PT_STACK) - sa_size -= 2; - - /* Decide whether to refer to objects off our PV via FP or PV. - If we need FP for something else or if we receive a nonlocal - goto (which expects PV to contain the value), we must use PV. - Otherwise, start by assuming we can use FP. */ - - vms_base_regno - = (frame_pointer_needed - || current_function_has_nonlocal_label - || alpha_procedure_type == PT_STACK - || current_function_outgoing_args_size) - ? REG_PV : HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM; - - /* If we want to copy PV into FP, we need to find some register - in which to save FP. */ - - vms_save_fp_regno = -1; - if (vms_base_regno == HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM) - for (i = 0; i < 32; i++) - if (! fixed_regs[i] && call_used_regs[i] && ! regs_ever_live[i]) - vms_save_fp_regno = i; - - if (vms_save_fp_regno == -1 && alpha_procedure_type == PT_REGISTER) - vms_base_regno = REG_PV, alpha_procedure_type = PT_STACK; - else if (alpha_procedure_type == PT_NULL) - vms_base_regno = REG_PV; - - /* Stack unwinding should be done via FP unless we use it for PV. */ - vms_unwind_regno = (vms_base_regno == REG_PV - ? HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM : STACK_POINTER_REGNUM); - - /* If this is a stack procedure, allow space for saving FP and RA. */ - if (alpha_procedure_type == PT_STACK) - sa_size += 2; - } - else - { - /* Our size must be even (multiple of 16 bytes). */ - if (sa_size & 1) - sa_size++; - } - - return sa_size * 8; -} - -/* Define the offset between two registers, one to be eliminated, - and the other its replacement, at the start of a routine. */ - -HOST_WIDE_INT -alpha_initial_elimination_offset (unsigned int from, - unsigned int to ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED) -{ - HOST_WIDE_INT ret; - - ret = alpha_sa_size (); - ret += ALPHA_ROUND (current_function_outgoing_args_size); - - if (from == FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM) - ; - else if (from == ARG_POINTER_REGNUM) - ret += (ALPHA_ROUND (get_frame_size () - + current_function_pretend_args_size) - - current_function_pretend_args_size); - else - abort (); - - return ret; -} - -int -alpha_pv_save_size (void) -{ - alpha_sa_size (); - return alpha_procedure_type == PT_STACK ? 8 : 0; -} - -int -alpha_using_fp (void) -{ - alpha_sa_size (); - return vms_unwind_regno == HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM; -} - -#if TARGET_ABI_OPEN_VMS - -const struct attribute_spec vms_attribute_table[] = -{ - /* { name, min_len, max_len, decl_req, type_req, fn_type_req, handler } */ - { "overlaid", 0, 0, true, false, false, NULL }, - { "global", 0, 0, true, false, false, NULL }, - { "initialize", 0, 0, true, false, false, NULL }, - { NULL, 0, 0, false, false, false, NULL } -}; - -#endif - -static int -find_lo_sum_using_gp (rtx *px, void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED) -{ - return GET_CODE (*px) == LO_SUM && XEXP (*px, 0) == pic_offset_table_rtx; -} - -int -alpha_find_lo_sum_using_gp (rtx insn) -{ - return for_each_rtx (&PATTERN (insn), find_lo_sum_using_gp, NULL) > 0; -} - -static int -alpha_does_function_need_gp (void) -{ - rtx insn; - - /* The GP being variable is an OSF abi thing. */ - if (! TARGET_ABI_OSF) - return 0; - - /* We need the gp to load the address of __mcount. */ - if (TARGET_PROFILING_NEEDS_GP && current_function_profile) - return 1; - - /* The code emitted by alpha_output_mi_thunk_osf uses the gp. */ - if (current_function_is_thunk) - return 1; - - /* The nonlocal receiver pattern assumes that the gp is valid for - the nested function. Reasonable because it's almost always set - correctly already. For the cases where that's wrong, make sure - the nested function loads its gp on entry. */ - if (current_function_has_nonlocal_goto) - return 1; - - /* If we need a GP (we have a LDSYM insn or a CALL_INSN), load it first. - Even if we are a static function, we still need to do this in case - our address is taken and passed to something like qsort. */ - - push_topmost_sequence (); - insn = get_insns (); - pop_topmost_sequence (); - - for (; insn; insn = NEXT_INSN (insn)) - if (INSN_P (insn) - && GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) != USE - && GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) != CLOBBER - && get_attr_usegp (insn)) - return 1; - - return 0; -} - - -/* Helper function to set RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P on instructions, including - sequences. */ - -static rtx -set_frame_related_p (void) -{ - rtx seq = get_insns (); - rtx insn; - - end_sequence (); - - if (!seq) - return NULL_RTX; - - if (INSN_P (seq)) - { - insn = seq; - while (insn != NULL_RTX) - { - RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (insn) = 1; - insn = NEXT_INSN (insn); - } - seq = emit_insn (seq); - } - else - { - seq = emit_insn (seq); - RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (seq) = 1; - } - return seq; -} - -#define FRP(exp) (start_sequence (), exp, set_frame_related_p ()) - -/* Generates a store with the proper unwind info attached. VALUE is - stored at BASE_REG+BASE_OFS. If FRAME_BIAS is non-zero, then BASE_REG - contains SP+FRAME_BIAS, and that is the unwind info that should be - generated. If FRAME_REG != VALUE, then VALUE is being stored on - behalf of FRAME_REG, and FRAME_REG should be present in the unwind. */ - -static void -emit_frame_store_1 (rtx value, rtx base_reg, HOST_WIDE_INT frame_bias, - HOST_WIDE_INT base_ofs, rtx frame_reg) -{ - rtx addr, mem, insn; - - addr = plus_constant (base_reg, base_ofs); - mem = gen_rtx_MEM (DImode, addr); - set_mem_alias_set (mem, alpha_sr_alias_set); - - insn = emit_move_insn (mem, value); - RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (insn) = 1; - - if (frame_bias || value != frame_reg) - { - if (frame_bias) - { - addr = plus_constant (stack_pointer_rtx, frame_bias + base_ofs); - mem = gen_rtx_MEM (DImode, addr); - } - - REG_NOTES (insn) - = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (REG_FRAME_RELATED_EXPR, - gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, mem, frame_reg), - REG_NOTES (insn)); - } -} - -static void -emit_frame_store (unsigned int regno, rtx base_reg, - HOST_WIDE_INT frame_bias, HOST_WIDE_INT base_ofs) -{ - rtx reg = gen_rtx_REG (DImode, regno); - emit_frame_store_1 (reg, base_reg, frame_bias, base_ofs, reg); -} - -/* Write function prologue. */ - -/* On vms we have two kinds of functions: - - - stack frame (PROC_STACK) - these are 'normal' functions with local vars and which are - calling other functions - - register frame (PROC_REGISTER) - keeps all data in registers, needs no stack - - We must pass this to the assembler so it can generate the - proper pdsc (procedure descriptor) - This is done with the '.pdesc' command. - - On not-vms, we don't really differentiate between the two, as we can - simply allocate stack without saving registers. */ - -void -alpha_expand_prologue (void) -{ - /* Registers to save. */ - unsigned long imask = 0; - unsigned long fmask = 0; - /* Stack space needed for pushing registers clobbered by us. */ - HOST_WIDE_INT sa_size; - /* Complete stack size needed. */ - HOST_WIDE_INT frame_size; - /* Offset from base reg to register save area. */ - HOST_WIDE_INT reg_offset; - rtx sa_reg; - int i; - - sa_size = alpha_sa_size (); - - frame_size = get_frame_size (); - if (TARGET_ABI_OPEN_VMS) - frame_size = ALPHA_ROUND (sa_size - + (alpha_procedure_type == PT_STACK ? 8 : 0) - + frame_size - + current_function_pretend_args_size); - else if (TARGET_ABI_UNICOSMK) - /* We have to allocate space for the DSIB if we generate a frame. */ - frame_size = ALPHA_ROUND (sa_size - + (alpha_procedure_type == PT_STACK ? 48 : 0)) - + ALPHA_ROUND (frame_size - + current_function_outgoing_args_size); - else - frame_size = (ALPHA_ROUND (current_function_outgoing_args_size) - + sa_size - + ALPHA_ROUND (frame_size - + current_function_pretend_args_size)); - - if (TARGET_ABI_OPEN_VMS) - reg_offset = 8; - else - reg_offset = ALPHA_ROUND (current_function_outgoing_args_size); - - alpha_sa_mask (&imask, &fmask); - - /* Emit an insn to reload GP, if needed. */ - if (TARGET_ABI_OSF) - { - alpha_function_needs_gp = alpha_does_function_need_gp (); - if (alpha_function_needs_gp) - emit_insn (gen_prologue_ldgp ()); - } - - /* TARGET_PROFILING_NEEDS_GP actually implies that we need to insert - the call to mcount ourselves, rather than having the linker do it - magically in response to -pg. Since _mcount has special linkage, - don't represent the call as a call. */ - if (TARGET_PROFILING_NEEDS_GP && current_function_profile) - emit_insn (gen_prologue_mcount ()); - - if (TARGET_ABI_UNICOSMK) - unicosmk_gen_dsib (&imask); - - /* Adjust the stack by the frame size. If the frame size is > 4096 - bytes, we need to be sure we probe somewhere in the first and last - 4096 bytes (we can probably get away without the latter test) and - every 8192 bytes in between. If the frame size is > 32768, we - do this in a loop. Otherwise, we generate the explicit probe - instructions. - - Note that we are only allowed to adjust sp once in the prologue. */ - - if (frame_size <= 32768) - { - if (frame_size > 4096) - { - int probed = 4096; - - do - emit_insn (gen_probe_stack (GEN_INT (TARGET_ABI_UNICOSMK - ? -probed + 64 - : -probed))); - while ((probed += 8192) < frame_size); - - /* We only have to do this probe if we aren't saving registers. */ - if (sa_size == 0 && probed + 4096 < frame_size) - emit_insn (gen_probe_stack (GEN_INT (-frame_size))); - } - - if (frame_size != 0) - FRP (emit_insn (gen_adddi3 (stack_pointer_rtx, stack_pointer_rtx, - GEN_INT (TARGET_ABI_UNICOSMK - ? -frame_size + 64 - : -frame_size)))); - } - else - { - /* Here we generate code to set R22 to SP + 4096 and set R23 to the - number of 8192 byte blocks to probe. We then probe each block - in the loop and then set SP to the proper location. If the - amount remaining is > 4096, we have to do one more probe if we - are not saving any registers. */ - - HOST_WIDE_INT blocks = (frame_size + 4096) / 8192; - HOST_WIDE_INT leftover = frame_size + 4096 - blocks * 8192; - rtx ptr = gen_rtx_REG (DImode, 22); - rtx count = gen_rtx_REG (DImode, 23); - rtx seq; - - emit_move_insn (count, GEN_INT (blocks)); - emit_insn (gen_adddi3 (ptr, stack_pointer_rtx, - GEN_INT (TARGET_ABI_UNICOSMK ? 4096 - 64 : 4096))); - - /* Because of the difficulty in emitting a new basic block this - late in the compilation, generate the loop as a single insn. */ - emit_insn (gen_prologue_stack_probe_loop (count, ptr)); - - if (leftover > 4096 && sa_size == 0) - { - rtx last = gen_rtx_MEM (DImode, plus_constant (ptr, -leftover)); - MEM_VOLATILE_P (last) = 1; - emit_move_insn (last, const0_rtx); - } - - if (TARGET_ABI_WINDOWS_NT) - { - /* For NT stack unwind (done by 'reverse execution'), it's - not OK to take the result of a loop, even though the value - is already in ptr, so we reload it via a single operation - and subtract it to sp. - - Yes, that's correct -- we have to reload the whole constant - into a temporary via ldah+lda then subtract from sp. */ - - HOST_WIDE_INT lo, hi; - lo = ((frame_size & 0xffff) ^ 0x8000) - 0x8000; - hi = frame_size - lo; - - emit_move_insn (ptr, GEN_INT (hi)); - emit_insn (gen_adddi3 (ptr, ptr, GEN_INT (lo))); - seq = emit_insn (gen_subdi3 (stack_pointer_rtx, stack_pointer_rtx, - ptr)); - } - else - { - seq = emit_insn (gen_adddi3 (stack_pointer_rtx, ptr, - GEN_INT (-leftover))); - } - - /* This alternative is special, because the DWARF code cannot - possibly intuit through the loop above. So we invent this - note it looks at instead. */ - RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (seq) = 1; - REG_NOTES (seq) - = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (REG_FRAME_RELATED_EXPR, - gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, stack_pointer_rtx, - gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, stack_pointer_rtx, - GEN_INT (TARGET_ABI_UNICOSMK - ? -frame_size + 64 - : -frame_size))), - REG_NOTES (seq)); - } - - if (!TARGET_ABI_UNICOSMK) - { - HOST_WIDE_INT sa_bias = 0; - - /* Cope with very large offsets to the register save area. */ - sa_reg = stack_pointer_rtx; - if (reg_offset + sa_size > 0x8000) - { - int low = ((reg_offset & 0xffff) ^ 0x8000) - 0x8000; - rtx sa_bias_rtx; - - if (low + sa_size <= 0x8000) - sa_bias = reg_offset - low, reg_offset = low; - else - sa_bias = reg_offset, reg_offset = 0; - - sa_reg = gen_rtx_REG (DImode, 24); - sa_bias_rtx = GEN_INT (sa_bias); - - if (add_operand (sa_bias_rtx, DImode)) - emit_insn (gen_adddi3 (sa_reg, stack_pointer_rtx, sa_bias_rtx)); - else - { - emit_move_insn (sa_reg, sa_bias_rtx); - emit_insn (gen_adddi3 (sa_reg, stack_pointer_rtx, sa_reg)); - } - } - - /* Save regs in stack order. Beginning with VMS PV. */ - if (TARGET_ABI_OPEN_VMS && alpha_procedure_type == PT_STACK) - emit_frame_store (REG_PV, stack_pointer_rtx, 0, 0); - - /* Save register RA next. */ - if (imask & (1UL << REG_RA)) - { - emit_frame_store (REG_RA, sa_reg, sa_bias, reg_offset); - imask &= ~(1UL << REG_RA); - reg_offset += 8; - } - - /* Now save any other registers required to be saved. */ - for (i = 0; i < 31; i++) - if (imask & (1UL << i)) - { - emit_frame_store (i, sa_reg, sa_bias, reg_offset); - reg_offset += 8; - } - - for (i = 0; i < 31; i++) - if (fmask & (1UL << i)) - { - emit_frame_store (i+32, sa_reg, sa_bias, reg_offset); - reg_offset += 8; - } - } - else if (TARGET_ABI_UNICOSMK && alpha_procedure_type == PT_STACK) - { - /* The standard frame on the T3E includes space for saving registers. - We just have to use it. We don't have to save the return address and - the old frame pointer here - they are saved in the DSIB. */ - - reg_offset = -56; - for (i = 9; i < 15; i++) - if (imask & (1UL << i)) - { - emit_frame_store (i, hard_frame_pointer_rtx, 0, reg_offset); - reg_offset -= 8; - } - for (i = 2; i < 10; i++) - if (fmask & (1UL << i)) - { - emit_frame_store (i+32, hard_frame_pointer_rtx, 0, reg_offset); - reg_offset -= 8; - } - } - - if (TARGET_ABI_OPEN_VMS) - { - if (alpha_procedure_type == PT_REGISTER) - /* Register frame procedures save the fp. - ?? Ought to have a dwarf2 save for this. */ - emit_move_insn (gen_rtx_REG (DImode, vms_save_fp_regno), - hard_frame_pointer_rtx); - - if (alpha_procedure_type != PT_NULL && vms_base_regno != REG_PV) - emit_insn (gen_force_movdi (gen_rtx_REG (DImode, vms_base_regno), - gen_rtx_REG (DImode, REG_PV))); - - if (alpha_procedure_type != PT_NULL - && vms_unwind_regno == HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM) - FRP (emit_move_insn (hard_frame_pointer_rtx, stack_pointer_rtx)); - - /* If we have to allocate space for outgoing args, do it now. */ - if (current_function_outgoing_args_size != 0) - { - rtx seq - = emit_move_insn (stack_pointer_rtx, - plus_constant - (hard_frame_pointer_rtx, - - (ALPHA_ROUND - (current_function_outgoing_args_size)))); - - /* Only set FRAME_RELATED_P on the stack adjustment we just emitted - if ! frame_pointer_needed. Setting the bit will change the CFA - computation rule to use sp again, which would be wrong if we had - frame_pointer_needed, as this means sp might move unpredictably - later on. - - Also, note that - frame_pointer_needed - => vms_unwind_regno == HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM - and - current_function_outgoing_args_size != 0 - => alpha_procedure_type != PT_NULL, - - so when we are not setting the bit here, we are guaranteed to - have emitted an FRP frame pointer update just before. */ - RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (seq) = ! frame_pointer_needed; - } - } - else if (!TARGET_ABI_UNICOSMK) - { - /* If we need a frame pointer, set it from the stack pointer. */ - if (frame_pointer_needed) - { - if (TARGET_CAN_FAULT_IN_PROLOGUE) - FRP (emit_move_insn (hard_frame_pointer_rtx, stack_pointer_rtx)); - else - /* This must always be the last instruction in the - prologue, thus we emit a special move + clobber. */ - FRP (emit_insn (gen_init_fp (hard_frame_pointer_rtx, - stack_pointer_rtx, sa_reg))); - } - } - - /* The ABIs for VMS and OSF/1 say that while we can schedule insns into - the prologue, for exception handling reasons, we cannot do this for - any insn that might fault. We could prevent this for mems with a - (clobber:BLK (scratch)), but this doesn't work for fp insns. So we - have to prevent all such scheduling with a blockage. - - Linux, on the other hand, never bothered to implement OSF/1's - exception handling, and so doesn't care about such things. Anyone - planning to use dwarf2 frame-unwind info can also omit the blockage. */ - - if (! TARGET_CAN_FAULT_IN_PROLOGUE) - emit_insn (gen_blockage ()); -} - -/* Output the textual info surrounding the prologue. */ - -void -alpha_start_function (FILE *file, const char *fnname, - tree decl ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED) -{ - unsigned long imask = 0; - unsigned long fmask = 0; - /* Stack space needed for pushing registers clobbered by us. */ - HOST_WIDE_INT sa_size; - /* Complete stack size needed. */ - unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT frame_size; - /* Offset from base reg to register save area. */ - HOST_WIDE_INT reg_offset; - char *entry_label = (char *) alloca (strlen (fnname) + 6); - int i; - - /* Don't emit an extern directive for functions defined in the same file. */ - if (TARGET_ABI_UNICOSMK) - { - tree name_tree; - name_tree = get_identifier (fnname); - TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (name_tree) = 1; - } - - alpha_fnname = fnname; - sa_size = alpha_sa_size (); - - frame_size = get_frame_size (); - if (TARGET_ABI_OPEN_VMS) - frame_size = ALPHA_ROUND (sa_size - + (alpha_procedure_type == PT_STACK ? 8 : 0) - + frame_size - + current_function_pretend_args_size); - else if (TARGET_ABI_UNICOSMK) - frame_size = ALPHA_ROUND (sa_size - + (alpha_procedure_type == PT_STACK ? 48 : 0)) - + ALPHA_ROUND (frame_size - + current_function_outgoing_args_size); - else - frame_size = (ALPHA_ROUND (current_function_outgoing_args_size) - + sa_size - + ALPHA_ROUND (frame_size - + current_function_pretend_args_size)); - - if (TARGET_ABI_OPEN_VMS) - reg_offset = 8; - else - reg_offset = ALPHA_ROUND (current_function_outgoing_args_size); - - alpha_sa_mask (&imask, &fmask); - - /* Ecoff can handle multiple .file directives, so put out file and lineno. - We have to do that before the .ent directive as we cannot switch - files within procedures with native ecoff because line numbers are - linked to procedure descriptors. - Outputting the lineno helps debugging of one line functions as they - would otherwise get no line number at all. Please note that we would - like to put out last_linenum from final.c, but it is not accessible. */ - - if (write_symbols == SDB_DEBUG) - { -#ifdef ASM_OUTPUT_SOURCE_FILENAME - ASM_OUTPUT_SOURCE_FILENAME (file, - DECL_SOURCE_FILE (current_function_decl)); -#endif -#ifdef ASM_OUTPUT_SOURCE_LINE - if (debug_info_level != DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE) - ASM_OUTPUT_SOURCE_LINE (file, - DECL_SOURCE_LINE (current_function_decl), 0); -#endif - } - - /* Issue function start and label. */ - if (TARGET_ABI_OPEN_VMS - || (!TARGET_ABI_UNICOSMK && !flag_inhibit_size_directive)) - { - fputs ("\t.ent ", file); - assemble_name (file, fnname); - putc ('\n', file); - - /* If the function needs GP, we'll write the "..ng" label there. - Otherwise, do it here. */ - if (TARGET_ABI_OSF - && ! alpha_function_needs_gp - && ! current_function_is_thunk) - { - putc ('$', file); - assemble_name (file, fnname); - fputs ("..ng:\n", file); - } - } - - strcpy (entry_label, fnname); - if (TARGET_ABI_OPEN_VMS) - strcat (entry_label, "..en"); - - /* For public functions, the label must be globalized by appending an - additional colon. */ - if (TARGET_ABI_UNICOSMK && TREE_PUBLIC (decl)) - strcat (entry_label, ":"); - - ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (file, entry_label); - inside_function = TRUE; - - if (TARGET_ABI_OPEN_VMS) - fprintf (file, "\t.base $%d\n", vms_base_regno); - - if (!TARGET_ABI_OPEN_VMS && !TARGET_ABI_UNICOSMK && TARGET_IEEE_CONFORMANT - && !flag_inhibit_size_directive) - { - /* Set flags in procedure descriptor to request IEEE-conformant - math-library routines. The value we set it to is PDSC_EXC_IEEE - (/usr/include/pdsc.h). */ - fputs ("\t.eflag 48\n", file); - } - - /* Set up offsets to alpha virtual arg/local debugging pointer. */ - alpha_auto_offset = -frame_size + current_function_pretend_args_size; - alpha_arg_offset = -frame_size + 48; - - /* Describe our frame. If the frame size is larger than an integer, - print it as zero to avoid an assembler error. We won't be - properly describing such a frame, but that's the best we can do. */ - if (TARGET_ABI_UNICOSMK) - ; - else if (TARGET_ABI_OPEN_VMS) - fprintf (file, "\t.frame $%d," HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC ",$26," - HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC "\n", - vms_unwind_regno, - frame_size >= (1UL << 31) ? 0 : frame_size, - reg_offset); - else if (!flag_inhibit_size_directive) - fprintf (file, "\t.frame $%d," HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC ",$26,%d\n", - (frame_pointer_needed - ? HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM : STACK_POINTER_REGNUM), - frame_size >= (1UL << 31) ? 0 : frame_size, - current_function_pretend_args_size); - - /* Describe which registers were spilled. */ - if (TARGET_ABI_UNICOSMK) - ; - else if (TARGET_ABI_OPEN_VMS) - { - if (imask) - /* ??? Does VMS care if mask contains ra? The old code didn't - set it, so I don't here. */ - fprintf (file, "\t.mask 0x%lx,0\n", imask & ~(1UL << REG_RA)); - if (fmask) - fprintf (file, "\t.fmask 0x%lx,0\n", fmask); - if (alpha_procedure_type == PT_REGISTER) - fprintf (file, "\t.fp_save $%d\n", vms_save_fp_regno); - } - else if (!flag_inhibit_size_directive) - { - if (imask) - { - fprintf (file, "\t.mask 0x%lx," HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC "\n", imask, - frame_size >= (1UL << 31) ? 0 : reg_offset - frame_size); - - for (i = 0; i < 32; ++i) - if (imask & (1UL << i)) - reg_offset += 8; - } - - if (fmask) - fprintf (file, "\t.fmask 0x%lx," HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC "\n", fmask, - frame_size >= (1UL << 31) ? 0 : reg_offset - frame_size); - } - -#if TARGET_ABI_OPEN_VMS - /* Ifdef'ed cause link_section are only available then. */ - readonly_data_section (); - fprintf (file, "\t.align 3\n"); - assemble_name (file, fnname); fputs ("..na:\n", file); - fputs ("\t.ascii \"", file); - assemble_name (file, fnname); - fputs ("\\0\"\n", file); - alpha_need_linkage (fnname, 1); - text_section (); -#endif -} - -/* Emit the .prologue note at the scheduled end of the prologue. */ - -static void -alpha_output_function_end_prologue (FILE *file) -{ - if (TARGET_ABI_UNICOSMK) - ; - else if (TARGET_ABI_OPEN_VMS) - fputs ("\t.prologue\n", file); - else if (TARGET_ABI_WINDOWS_NT) - fputs ("\t.prologue 0\n", file); - else if (!flag_inhibit_size_directive) - fprintf (file, "\t.prologue %d\n", - alpha_function_needs_gp || current_function_is_thunk); -} - -/* Write function epilogue. */ - -/* ??? At some point we will want to support full unwind, and so will - need to mark the epilogue as well. At the moment, we just confuse - dwarf2out. */ -#undef FRP -#define FRP(exp) exp - -void -alpha_expand_epilogue (void) -{ - /* Registers to save. */ - unsigned long imask = 0; - unsigned long fmask = 0; - /* Stack space needed for pushing registers clobbered by us. */ - HOST_WIDE_INT sa_size; - /* Complete stack size needed. */ - HOST_WIDE_INT frame_size; - /* Offset from base reg to register save area. */ - HOST_WIDE_INT reg_offset; - int fp_is_frame_pointer, fp_offset; - rtx sa_reg, sa_reg_exp = NULL; - rtx sp_adj1, sp_adj2, mem; - rtx eh_ofs; - int i; - - sa_size = alpha_sa_size (); - - frame_size = get_frame_size (); - if (TARGET_ABI_OPEN_VMS) - frame_size = ALPHA_ROUND (sa_size - + (alpha_procedure_type == PT_STACK ? 8 : 0) - + frame_size - + current_function_pretend_args_size); - else if (TARGET_ABI_UNICOSMK) - frame_size = ALPHA_ROUND (sa_size - + (alpha_procedure_type == PT_STACK ? 48 : 0)) - + ALPHA_ROUND (frame_size - + current_function_outgoing_args_size); - else - frame_size = (ALPHA_ROUND (current_function_outgoing_args_size) - + sa_size - + ALPHA_ROUND (frame_size - + current_function_pretend_args_size)); - - if (TARGET_ABI_OPEN_VMS) - { - if (alpha_procedure_type == PT_STACK) - reg_offset = 8; - else - reg_offset = 0; - } - else - reg_offset = ALPHA_ROUND (current_function_outgoing_args_size); - - alpha_sa_mask (&imask, &fmask); - - fp_is_frame_pointer - = ((TARGET_ABI_OPEN_VMS && alpha_procedure_type == PT_STACK) - || (!TARGET_ABI_OPEN_VMS && frame_pointer_needed)); - fp_offset = 0; - sa_reg = stack_pointer_rtx; - - if (current_function_calls_eh_return) - eh_ofs = EH_RETURN_STACKADJ_RTX; - else - eh_ofs = NULL_RTX; - - if (!TARGET_ABI_UNICOSMK && sa_size) - { - /* If we have a frame pointer, restore SP from it. */ - if ((TARGET_ABI_OPEN_VMS - && vms_unwind_regno == HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM) - || (!TARGET_ABI_OPEN_VMS && frame_pointer_needed)) - FRP (emit_move_insn (stack_pointer_rtx, hard_frame_pointer_rtx)); - - /* Cope with very large offsets to the register save area. */ - if (reg_offset + sa_size > 0x8000) - { - int low = ((reg_offset & 0xffff) ^ 0x8000) - 0x8000; - HOST_WIDE_INT bias; - - if (low + sa_size <= 0x8000) - bias = reg_offset - low, reg_offset = low; - else - bias = reg_offset, reg_offset = 0; - - sa_reg = gen_rtx_REG (DImode, 22); - sa_reg_exp = plus_constant (stack_pointer_rtx, bias); - - FRP (emit_move_insn (sa_reg, sa_reg_exp)); - } - - /* Restore registers in order, excepting a true frame pointer. */ - - mem = gen_rtx_MEM (DImode, plus_constant (sa_reg, reg_offset)); - if (! eh_ofs) - set_mem_alias_set (mem, alpha_sr_alias_set); - FRP (emit_move_insn (gen_rtx_REG (DImode, REG_RA), mem)); - - reg_offset += 8; - imask &= ~(1UL << REG_RA); - - for (i = 0; i < 31; ++i) - if (imask & (1UL << i)) - { - if (i == HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM && fp_is_frame_pointer) - fp_offset = reg_offset; - else - { - mem = gen_rtx_MEM (DImode, plus_constant(sa_reg, reg_offset)); - set_mem_alias_set (mem, alpha_sr_alias_set); - FRP (emit_move_insn (gen_rtx_REG (DImode, i), mem)); - } - reg_offset += 8; - } - - for (i = 0; i < 31; ++i) - if (fmask & (1UL << i)) - { - mem = gen_rtx_MEM (DFmode, plus_constant(sa_reg, reg_offset)); - set_mem_alias_set (mem, alpha_sr_alias_set); - FRP (emit_move_insn (gen_rtx_REG (DFmode, i+32), mem)); - reg_offset += 8; - } - } - else if (TARGET_ABI_UNICOSMK && alpha_procedure_type == PT_STACK) - { - /* Restore callee-saved general-purpose registers. */ - - reg_offset = -56; - - for (i = 9; i < 15; i++) - if (imask & (1UL << i)) - { - mem = gen_rtx_MEM (DImode, plus_constant(hard_frame_pointer_rtx, - reg_offset)); - set_mem_alias_set (mem, alpha_sr_alias_set); - FRP (emit_move_insn (gen_rtx_REG (DImode, i), mem)); - reg_offset -= 8; - } - - for (i = 2; i < 10; i++) - if (fmask & (1UL << i)) - { - mem = gen_rtx_MEM (DFmode, plus_constant(hard_frame_pointer_rtx, - reg_offset)); - set_mem_alias_set (mem, alpha_sr_alias_set); - FRP (emit_move_insn (gen_rtx_REG (DFmode, i+32), mem)); - reg_offset -= 8; - } - - /* Restore the return address from the DSIB. */ - - mem = gen_rtx_MEM (DImode, plus_constant(hard_frame_pointer_rtx, -8)); - set_mem_alias_set (mem, alpha_sr_alias_set); - FRP (emit_move_insn (gen_rtx_REG (DImode, REG_RA), mem)); - } - - if (frame_size || eh_ofs) - { - sp_adj1 = stack_pointer_rtx; - - if (eh_ofs) - { - sp_adj1 = gen_rtx_REG (DImode, 23); - emit_move_insn (sp_adj1, - gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, stack_pointer_rtx, eh_ofs)); - } - - /* If the stack size is large, begin computation into a temporary - register so as not to interfere with a potential fp restore, - which must be consecutive with an SP restore. */ - if (frame_size < 32768 - && ! (TARGET_ABI_UNICOSMK && current_function_calls_alloca)) - sp_adj2 = GEN_INT (frame_size); - else if (TARGET_ABI_UNICOSMK) - { - sp_adj1 = gen_rtx_REG (DImode, 23); - FRP (emit_move_insn (sp_adj1, hard_frame_pointer_rtx)); - sp_adj2 = const0_rtx; - } - else if (frame_size < 0x40007fffL) - { - int low = ((frame_size & 0xffff) ^ 0x8000) - 0x8000; - - sp_adj2 = plus_constant (sp_adj1, frame_size - low); - if (sa_reg_exp && rtx_equal_p (sa_reg_exp, sp_adj2)) - sp_adj1 = sa_reg; - else - { - sp_adj1 = gen_rtx_REG (DImode, 23); - FRP (emit_move_insn (sp_adj1, sp_adj2)); - } - sp_adj2 = GEN_INT (low); - } - else - { - rtx tmp = gen_rtx_REG (DImode, 23); - FRP (sp_adj2 = alpha_emit_set_const (tmp, DImode, frame_size, 3)); - if (!sp_adj2) - { - /* We can't drop new things to memory this late, afaik, - so build it up by pieces. */ - FRP (sp_adj2 = alpha_emit_set_long_const (tmp, frame_size, - -(frame_size < 0))); - if (!sp_adj2) - abort (); - } - } - - /* From now on, things must be in order. So emit blockages. */ - - /* Restore the frame pointer. */ - if (TARGET_ABI_UNICOSMK) - { - emit_insn (gen_blockage ()); - mem = gen_rtx_MEM (DImode, - plus_constant (hard_frame_pointer_rtx, -16)); - set_mem_alias_set (mem, alpha_sr_alias_set); - FRP (emit_move_insn (hard_frame_pointer_rtx, mem)); - } - else if (fp_is_frame_pointer) - { - emit_insn (gen_blockage ()); - mem = gen_rtx_MEM (DImode, plus_constant (sa_reg, fp_offset)); - set_mem_alias_set (mem, alpha_sr_alias_set); - FRP (emit_move_insn (hard_frame_pointer_rtx, mem)); - } - else if (TARGET_ABI_OPEN_VMS) - { - emit_insn (gen_blockage ()); - FRP (emit_move_insn (hard_frame_pointer_rtx, - gen_rtx_REG (DImode, vms_save_fp_regno))); - } - - /* Restore the stack pointer. */ - emit_insn (gen_blockage ()); - if (sp_adj2 == const0_rtx) - FRP (emit_move_insn (stack_pointer_rtx, sp_adj1)); - else - FRP (emit_move_insn (stack_pointer_rtx, - gen_rtx_PLUS (DImode, sp_adj1, sp_adj2))); - } - else - { - if (TARGET_ABI_OPEN_VMS && alpha_procedure_type == PT_REGISTER) - { - emit_insn (gen_blockage ()); - FRP (emit_move_insn (hard_frame_pointer_rtx, - gen_rtx_REG (DImode, vms_save_fp_regno))); - } - else if (TARGET_ABI_UNICOSMK && alpha_procedure_type != PT_STACK) - { - /* Decrement the frame pointer if the function does not have a - frame. */ - - emit_insn (gen_blockage ()); - FRP (emit_insn (gen_adddi3 (hard_frame_pointer_rtx, - hard_frame_pointer_rtx, GEN_INT (-1)))); - } - } -} - -/* Output the rest of the textual info surrounding the epilogue. */ - -void -alpha_end_function (FILE *file, const char *fnname, tree decl ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED) -{ - /* End the function. */ - if (!TARGET_ABI_UNICOSMK && !flag_inhibit_size_directive) - { - fputs ("\t.end ", file); - assemble_name (file, fnname); - putc ('\n', file); - } - inside_function = FALSE; - -#if TARGET_ABI_OPEN_VMS - alpha_write_linkage (file, fnname, decl); -#endif - - /* Output jump tables and the static subroutine information block. */ - if (TARGET_ABI_UNICOSMK) - { - unicosmk_output_ssib (file, fnname); - unicosmk_output_deferred_case_vectors (file); - } -} - -#if TARGET_ABI_OSF -/* Emit a tail call to FUNCTION after adjusting THIS by DELTA. - - In order to avoid the hordes of differences between generated code - with and without TARGET_EXPLICIT_RELOCS, and to avoid duplicating - lots of code loading up large constants, generate rtl and emit it - instead of going straight to text. - - Not sure why this idea hasn't been explored before... */ - -static void -alpha_output_mi_thunk_osf (FILE *file, tree thunk_fndecl ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, - HOST_WIDE_INT delta, HOST_WIDE_INT vcall_offset, - tree function) -{ - HOST_WIDE_INT hi, lo; - rtx this, insn, funexp; - - /* We always require a valid GP. */ - emit_insn (gen_prologue_ldgp ()); - emit_note (NOTE_INSN_PROLOGUE_END); - - /* Find the "this" pointer. If the function returns a structure, - the structure return pointer is in $16. */ - if (aggregate_value_p (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (function)), function)) - this = gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, 17); - else - this = gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, 16); - - /* Add DELTA. When possible we use ldah+lda. Otherwise load the - entire constant for the add. */ - lo = ((delta & 0xffff) ^ 0x8000) - 0x8000; - hi = (((delta - lo) & 0xffffffff) ^ 0x80000000) - 0x80000000; - if (hi + lo == delta) - { - if (hi) - emit_insn (gen_adddi3 (this, this, GEN_INT (hi))); - if (lo) - emit_insn (gen_adddi3 (this, this, GEN_INT (lo))); - } - else - { - rtx tmp = alpha_emit_set_long_const (gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, 0), - delta, -(delta < 0)); - emit_insn (gen_adddi3 (this, this, tmp)); - } - - /* Add a delta stored in the vtable at VCALL_OFFSET. */ - if (vcall_offset) - { - rtx tmp, tmp2; - - tmp = gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, 0); - emit_move_insn (tmp, gen_rtx_MEM (Pmode, this)); - - lo = ((vcall_offset & 0xffff) ^ 0x8000) - 0x8000; - hi = (((vcall_offset - lo) & 0xffffffff) ^ 0x80000000) - 0x80000000; - if (hi + lo == vcall_offset) - { - if (hi) - emit_insn (gen_adddi3 (tmp, tmp, GEN_INT (hi))); - } - else - { - tmp2 = alpha_emit_set_long_const (gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, 1), - vcall_offset, -(vcall_offset < 0)); - emit_insn (gen_adddi3 (tmp, tmp, tmp2)); - lo = 0; - } - if (lo) - tmp2 = gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, tmp, GEN_INT (lo)); - else - tmp2 = tmp; - emit_move_insn (tmp, gen_rtx_MEM (Pmode, tmp2)); - - emit_insn (gen_adddi3 (this, this, tmp)); - } - - /* Generate a tail call to the target function. */ - if (! TREE_USED (function)) - { - assemble_external (function); - TREE_USED (function) = 1; - } - funexp = XEXP (DECL_RTL (function), 0); - funexp = gen_rtx_MEM (FUNCTION_MODE, funexp); - insn = emit_call_insn (gen_sibcall (funexp, const0_rtx)); - SIBLING_CALL_P (insn) = 1; - - /* Run just enough of rest_of_compilation to get the insns emitted. - There's not really enough bulk here to make other passes such as - instruction scheduling worth while. Note that use_thunk calls - assemble_start_function and assemble_end_function. */ - insn = get_insns (); - insn_locators_initialize (); - shorten_branches (insn); - final_start_function (insn, file, 1); - final (insn, file, 1, 0); - final_end_function (); -} -#endif /* TARGET_ABI_OSF */ - -/* Debugging support. */ - -#include "gstab.h" - -/* Count the number of sdb related labels are generated (to find block - start and end boundaries). */ - -int sdb_label_count = 0; - -/* Next label # for each statement. */ - -static int sym_lineno = 0; - -/* Count the number of .file directives, so that .loc is up to date. */ - -static int num_source_filenames = 0; - -/* Name of the file containing the current function. */ - -static const char *current_function_file = ""; - -/* Offsets to alpha virtual arg/local debugging pointers. */ - -long alpha_arg_offset; -long alpha_auto_offset; - -/* Emit a new filename to a stream. */ - -void -alpha_output_filename (FILE *stream, const char *name) -{ - static int first_time = TRUE; - char ltext_label_name[100]; - - if (first_time) - { - first_time = FALSE; - ++num_source_filenames; - current_function_file = name; - fprintf (stream, "\t.file\t%d ", num_source_filenames); - output_quoted_string (stream, name); - fprintf (stream, "\n"); - if (!TARGET_GAS && write_symbols == DBX_DEBUG) - fprintf (stream, "\t#@stabs\n"); - } - - else if (write_symbols == DBX_DEBUG) - { - ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (ltext_label_name, "Ltext", 0); - fprintf (stream, "%s", ASM_STABS_OP); - output_quoted_string (stream, name); - fprintf (stream, ",%d,0,0,%s\n", N_SOL, <ext_label_name[1]); - } - - else if (name != current_function_file - && strcmp (name, current_function_file) != 0) - { - if (inside_function && ! TARGET_GAS) - fprintf (stream, "\t#.file\t%d ", num_source_filenames); - else - { - ++num_source_filenames; - current_function_file = name; - fprintf (stream, "\t.file\t%d ", num_source_filenames); - } - - output_quoted_string (stream, name); - fprintf (stream, "\n"); - } -} - -/* Emit a linenumber to a stream. */ - -void -alpha_output_lineno (FILE *stream, int line) -{ - if (write_symbols == DBX_DEBUG) - { - /* mips-tfile doesn't understand .stabd directives. */ - ++sym_lineno; - fprintf (stream, "$LM%d:\n%s%d,0,%d,$LM%d\n", - sym_lineno, ASM_STABN_OP, N_SLINE, line, sym_lineno); - } - else - fprintf (stream, "\n\t.loc\t%d %d\n", num_source_filenames, line); -} - -/* Structure to show the current status of registers and memory. */ - -struct shadow_summary -{ - struct { - unsigned int i : 31; /* Mask of int regs */ - unsigned int fp : 31; /* Mask of fp regs */ - unsigned int mem : 1; /* mem == imem | fpmem */ - } used, defd; -}; - -/* Summary the effects of expression X on the machine. Update SUM, a pointer - to the summary structure. SET is nonzero if the insn is setting the - object, otherwise zero. */ - -static void -summarize_insn (rtx x, struct shadow_summary *sum, int set) -{ - const char *format_ptr; - int i, j; - - if (x == 0) - return; - - switch (GET_CODE (x)) - { - /* ??? Note that this case would be incorrect if the Alpha had a - ZERO_EXTRACT in SET_DEST. */ - case SET: - summarize_insn (SET_SRC (x), sum, 0); - summarize_insn (SET_DEST (x), sum, 1); - break; - - case CLOBBER: - summarize_insn (XEXP (x, 0), sum, 1); - break; - - case USE: - summarize_insn (XEXP (x, 0), sum, 0); - break; - - case ASM_OPERANDS: - for (i = ASM_OPERANDS_INPUT_LENGTH (x) - 1; i >= 0; i--) - summarize_insn (ASM_OPERANDS_INPUT (x, i), sum, 0); - break; - - case PARALLEL: - for (i = XVECLEN (x, 0) - 1; i >= 0; i--) - summarize_insn (XVECEXP (x, 0, i), sum, 0); - break; - - case SUBREG: - summarize_insn (SUBREG_REG (x), sum, 0); - break; - - case REG: - { - int regno = REGNO (x); - unsigned long mask = ((unsigned long) 1) << (regno % 32); - - if (regno == 31 || regno == 63) - break; - - if (set) - { - if (regno < 32) - sum->defd.i |= mask; - else - sum->defd.fp |= mask; - } - else - { - if (regno < 32) - sum->used.i |= mask; - else - sum->used.fp |= mask; - } - } - break; - - case MEM: - if (set) - sum->defd.mem = 1; - else - sum->used.mem = 1; - - /* Find the regs used in memory address computation: */ - summarize_insn (XEXP (x, 0), sum, 0); - break; - - case CONST_INT: case CONST_DOUBLE: - case SYMBOL_REF: case LABEL_REF: case CONST: - case SCRATCH: case ASM_INPUT: - break; - - /* Handle common unary and binary ops for efficiency. */ - case COMPARE: case PLUS: case MINUS: case MULT: case DIV: - case MOD: case UDIV: case UMOD: case AND: case IOR: - case XOR: case ASHIFT: case ROTATE: case ASHIFTRT: case LSHIFTRT: - case ROTATERT: case SMIN: case SMAX: case UMIN: case UMAX: - case NE: case EQ: case GE: case GT: case LE: - case LT: case GEU: case GTU: case LEU: case LTU: - summarize_insn (XEXP (x, 0), sum, 0); - summarize_insn (XEXP (x, 1), sum, 0); - break; - - case NEG: case NOT: case SIGN_EXTEND: case ZERO_EXTEND: - case TRUNCATE: case FLOAT_EXTEND: case FLOAT_TRUNCATE: case FLOAT: - case FIX: case UNSIGNED_FLOAT: case UNSIGNED_FIX: case ABS: - case SQRT: case FFS: - summarize_insn (XEXP (x, 0), sum, 0); - break; - - default: - format_ptr = GET_RTX_FORMAT (GET_CODE (x)); - for (i = GET_RTX_LENGTH (GET_CODE (x)) - 1; i >= 0; i--) - switch (format_ptr[i]) - { - case 'e': - summarize_insn (XEXP (x, i), sum, 0); - break; - - case 'E': - for (j = XVECLEN (x, i) - 1; j >= 0; j--) - summarize_insn (XVECEXP (x, i, j), sum, 0); - break; - - case 'i': - break; - - default: - abort (); - } - } -} - -/* Ensure a sufficient number of `trapb' insns are in the code when - the user requests code with a trap precision of functions or - instructions. - - In naive mode, when the user requests a trap-precision of - "instruction", a trapb is needed after every instruction that may - generate a trap. This ensures that the code is resumption safe but - it is also slow. - - When optimizations are turned on, we delay issuing a trapb as long - as possible. In this context, a trap shadow is the sequence of - instructions that starts with a (potentially) trap generating - instruction and extends to the next trapb or call_pal instruction - (but GCC never generates call_pal by itself). We can delay (and - therefore sometimes omit) a trapb subject to the following - conditions: - - (a) On entry to the trap shadow, if any Alpha register or memory - location contains a value that is used as an operand value by some - instruction in the trap shadow (live on entry), then no instruction - in the trap shadow may modify the register or memory location. - - (b) Within the trap shadow, the computation of the base register - for a memory load or store instruction may not involve using the - result of an instruction that might generate an UNPREDICTABLE - result. - - (c) Within the trap shadow, no register may be used more than once - as a destination register. (This is to make life easier for the - trap-handler.) - - (d) The trap shadow may not include any branch instructions. */ - -static void -alpha_handle_trap_shadows (void) -{ - struct shadow_summary shadow; - int trap_pending, exception_nesting; - rtx i, n; - - trap_pending = 0; - exception_nesting = 0; - shadow.used.i = 0; - shadow.used.fp = 0; - shadow.used.mem = 0; - shadow.defd = shadow.used; - - for (i = get_insns (); i ; i = NEXT_INSN (i)) - { - if (GET_CODE (i) == NOTE) - { - switch (NOTE_LINE_NUMBER (i)) - { - case NOTE_INSN_EH_REGION_BEG: - exception_nesting++; - if (trap_pending) - goto close_shadow; - break; - - case NOTE_INSN_EH_REGION_END: - exception_nesting--; - if (trap_pending) - goto close_shadow; - break; - - case NOTE_INSN_EPILOGUE_BEG: - if (trap_pending && alpha_tp >= ALPHA_TP_FUNC) - goto close_shadow; - break; - } - } - else if (trap_pending) - { - if (alpha_tp == ALPHA_TP_FUNC) - { - if (GET_CODE (i) == JUMP_INSN - && GET_CODE (PATTERN (i)) == RETURN) - goto close_shadow; - } - else if (alpha_tp == ALPHA_TP_INSN) - { - if (optimize > 0) - { - struct shadow_summary sum; - - sum.used.i = 0; - sum.used.fp = 0; - sum.used.mem = 0; - sum.defd = sum.used; - - switch (GET_CODE (i)) - { - case INSN: - /* Annoyingly, get_attr_trap will abort on these. */ - if (GET_CODE (PATTERN (i)) == USE - || GET_CODE (PATTERN (i)) == CLOBBER) - break; - - summarize_insn (PATTERN (i), &sum, 0); - - if ((sum.defd.i & shadow.defd.i) - || (sum.defd.fp & shadow.defd.fp)) - { - /* (c) would be violated */ - goto close_shadow; - } - - /* Combine shadow with summary of current insn: */ - shadow.used.i |= sum.used.i; - shadow.used.fp |= sum.used.fp; - shadow.used.mem |= sum.used.mem; - shadow.defd.i |= sum.defd.i; - shadow.defd.fp |= sum.defd.fp; - shadow.defd.mem |= sum.defd.mem; - - if ((sum.defd.i & shadow.used.i) - || (sum.defd.fp & shadow.used.fp) - || (sum.defd.mem & shadow.used.mem)) - { - /* (a) would be violated (also takes care of (b)) */ - if (get_attr_trap (i) == TRAP_YES - && ((sum.defd.i & sum.used.i) - || (sum.defd.fp & sum.used.fp))) - abort (); - - goto close_shadow; - } - break; - - case JUMP_INSN: - case CALL_INSN: - case CODE_LABEL: - goto close_shadow; - - default: - abort (); - } - } - else - { - close_shadow: - n = emit_insn_before (gen_trapb (), i); - PUT_MODE (n, TImode); - PUT_MODE (i, TImode); - trap_pending = 0; - shadow.used.i = 0; - shadow.used.fp = 0; - shadow.used.mem = 0; - shadow.defd = shadow.used; - } - } - } - - if ((exception_nesting > 0 || alpha_tp >= ALPHA_TP_FUNC) - && GET_CODE (i) == INSN - && GET_CODE (PATTERN (i)) != USE - && GET_CODE (PATTERN (i)) != CLOBBER - && get_attr_trap (i) == TRAP_YES) - { - if (optimize && !trap_pending) - summarize_insn (PATTERN (i), &shadow, 0); - trap_pending = 1; - } - } -} - -/* Alpha can only issue instruction groups simultaneously if they are - suitably aligned. This is very processor-specific. */ - -enum alphaev4_pipe { - EV4_STOP = 0, - EV4_IB0 = 1, - EV4_IB1 = 2, - EV4_IBX = 4 -}; - -enum alphaev5_pipe { - EV5_STOP = 0, - EV5_NONE = 1, - EV5_E01 = 2, - EV5_E0 = 4, - EV5_E1 = 8, - EV5_FAM = 16, - EV5_FA = 32, - EV5_FM = 64 -}; - -static enum alphaev4_pipe -alphaev4_insn_pipe (rtx insn) -{ - if (recog_memoized (insn) < 0) - return EV4_STOP; - if (get_attr_length (insn) != 4) - return EV4_STOP; - - switch (get_attr_type (insn)) - { - case TYPE_ILD: - case TYPE_FLD: - return EV4_IBX; - - case TYPE_LDSYM: - case TYPE_IADD: - case TYPE_ILOG: - case TYPE_ICMOV: - case TYPE_ICMP: - case TYPE_IST: - case TYPE_FST: - case TYPE_SHIFT: - case TYPE_IMUL: - case TYPE_FBR: - return EV4_IB0; - - case TYPE_MISC: - case TYPE_IBR: - case TYPE_JSR: - case TYPE_CALLPAL: - case TYPE_FCPYS: - case TYPE_FCMOV: - case TYPE_FADD: - case TYPE_FDIV: - case TYPE_FMUL: - return EV4_IB1; - - default: - abort (); - } -} - -static enum alphaev5_pipe -alphaev5_insn_pipe (rtx insn) -{ - if (recog_memoized (insn) < 0) - return EV5_STOP; - if (get_attr_length (insn) != 4) - return EV5_STOP; - - switch (get_attr_type (insn)) - { - case TYPE_ILD: - case TYPE_FLD: - case TYPE_LDSYM: - case TYPE_IADD: - case TYPE_ILOG: - case TYPE_ICMOV: - case TYPE_ICMP: - return EV5_E01; - - case TYPE_IST: - case TYPE_FST: - case TYPE_SHIFT: - case TYPE_IMUL: - case TYPE_MISC: - case TYPE_MVI: - return EV5_E0; - - case TYPE_IBR: - case TYPE_JSR: - case TYPE_CALLPAL: - return EV5_E1; - - case TYPE_FCPYS: - return EV5_FAM; - - case TYPE_FBR: - case TYPE_FCMOV: - case TYPE_FADD: - case TYPE_FDIV: - return EV5_FA; - - case TYPE_FMUL: - return EV5_FM; - - default: - abort(); - } -} - -/* IN_USE is a mask of the slots currently filled within the insn group. - The mask bits come from alphaev4_pipe above. If EV4_IBX is set, then - the insn in EV4_IB0 can be swapped by the hardware into EV4_IB1. - - LEN is, of course, the length of the group in bytes. */ - -static rtx -alphaev4_next_group (rtx insn, int *pin_use, int *plen) -{ - int len, in_use; - - len = in_use = 0; - - if (! INSN_P (insn) - || GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == CLOBBER - || GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == USE) - goto next_and_done; - - while (1) - { - enum alphaev4_pipe pipe; - - pipe = alphaev4_insn_pipe (insn); - switch (pipe) - { - case EV4_STOP: - /* Force complex instructions to start new groups. */ - if (in_use) - goto done; - - /* If this is a completely unrecognized insn, its an asm. - We don't know how long it is, so record length as -1 to - signal a needed realignment. */ - if (recog_memoized (insn) < 0) - len = -1; - else - len = get_attr_length (insn); - goto next_and_done; - - case EV4_IBX: - if (in_use & EV4_IB0) - { - if (in_use & EV4_IB1) - goto done; - in_use |= EV4_IB1; - } - else - in_use |= EV4_IB0 | EV4_IBX; - break; - - case EV4_IB0: - if (in_use & EV4_IB0) - { - if (!(in_use & EV4_IBX) || (in_use & EV4_IB1)) - goto done; - in_use |= EV4_IB1; - } - in_use |= EV4_IB0; - break; - - case EV4_IB1: - if (in_use & EV4_IB1) - goto done; - in_use |= EV4_IB1; - break; - - default: - abort(); - } - len += 4; - - /* Haifa doesn't do well scheduling branches. */ - if (GET_CODE (insn) == JUMP_INSN) - goto next_and_done; - - next: - insn = next_nonnote_insn (insn); - - if (!insn || ! INSN_P (insn)) - goto done; - - /* Let Haifa tell us where it thinks insn group boundaries are. */ - if (GET_MODE (insn) == TImode) - goto done; - - if (GET_CODE (insn) == CLOBBER || GET_CODE (insn) == USE) - goto next; - } - - next_and_done: - insn = next_nonnote_insn (insn); - - done: - *plen = len; - *pin_use = in_use; - return insn; -} - -/* IN_USE is a mask of the slots currently filled within the insn group. - The mask bits come from alphaev5_pipe above. If EV5_E01 is set, then - the insn in EV5_E0 can be swapped by the hardware into EV5_E1. - - LEN is, of course, the length of the group in bytes. */ - -static rtx -alphaev5_next_group (rtx insn, int *pin_use, int *plen) -{ - int len, in_use; - - len = in_use = 0; - - if (! INSN_P (insn) - || GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == CLOBBER - || GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == USE) - goto next_and_done; - - while (1) - { - enum alphaev5_pipe pipe; - - pipe = alphaev5_insn_pipe (insn); - switch (pipe) - { - case EV5_STOP: - /* Force complex instructions to start new groups. */ - if (in_use) - goto done; - - /* If this is a completely unrecognized insn, its an asm. - We don't know how long it is, so record length as -1 to - signal a needed realignment. */ - if (recog_memoized (insn) < 0) - len = -1; - else - len = get_attr_length (insn); - goto next_and_done; - - /* ??? Most of the places below, we would like to abort, as - it would indicate an error either in Haifa, or in the - scheduling description. Unfortunately, Haifa never - schedules the last instruction of the BB, so we don't - have an accurate TI bit to go off. */ - case EV5_E01: - if (in_use & EV5_E0) - { - if (in_use & EV5_E1) - goto done; - in_use |= EV5_E1; - } - else - in_use |= EV5_E0 | EV5_E01; - break; - - case EV5_E0: - if (in_use & EV5_E0) - { - if (!(in_use & EV5_E01) || (in_use & EV5_E1)) - goto done; - in_use |= EV5_E1; - } - in_use |= EV5_E0; - break; - - case EV5_E1: - if (in_use & EV5_E1) - goto done; - in_use |= EV5_E1; - break; - - case EV5_FAM: - if (in_use & EV5_FA) - { - if (in_use & EV5_FM) - goto done; - in_use |= EV5_FM; - } - else - in_use |= EV5_FA | EV5_FAM; - break; - - case EV5_FA: - if (in_use & EV5_FA) - goto done; - in_use |= EV5_FA; - break; - - case EV5_FM: - if (in_use & EV5_FM) - goto done; - in_use |= EV5_FM; - break; - - case EV5_NONE: - break; - - default: - abort(); - } - len += 4; - - /* Haifa doesn't do well scheduling branches. */ - /* ??? If this is predicted not-taken, slotting continues, except - that no more IBR, FBR, or JSR insns may be slotted. */ - if (GET_CODE (insn) == JUMP_INSN) - goto next_and_done; - - next: - insn = next_nonnote_insn (insn); - - if (!insn || ! INSN_P (insn)) - goto done; - - /* Let Haifa tell us where it thinks insn group boundaries are. */ - if (GET_MODE (insn) == TImode) - goto done; - - if (GET_CODE (insn) == CLOBBER || GET_CODE (insn) == USE) - goto next; - } - - next_and_done: - insn = next_nonnote_insn (insn); - - done: - *plen = len; - *pin_use = in_use; - return insn; -} - -static rtx -alphaev4_next_nop (int *pin_use) -{ - int in_use = *pin_use; - rtx nop; - - if (!(in_use & EV4_IB0)) - { - in_use |= EV4_IB0; - nop = gen_nop (); - } - else if ((in_use & (EV4_IBX|EV4_IB1)) == EV4_IBX) - { - in_use |= EV4_IB1; - nop = gen_nop (); - } - else if (TARGET_FP && !(in_use & EV4_IB1)) - { - in_use |= EV4_IB1; - nop = gen_fnop (); - } - else - nop = gen_unop (); - - *pin_use = in_use; - return nop; -} - -static rtx -alphaev5_next_nop (int *pin_use) -{ - int in_use = *pin_use; - rtx nop; - - if (!(in_use & EV5_E1)) - { - in_use |= EV5_E1; - nop = gen_nop (); - } - else if (TARGET_FP && !(in_use & EV5_FA)) - { - in_use |= EV5_FA; - nop = gen_fnop (); - } - else if (TARGET_FP && !(in_use & EV5_FM)) - { - in_use |= EV5_FM; - nop = gen_fnop (); - } - else - nop = gen_unop (); - - *pin_use = in_use; - return nop; -} - -/* The instruction group alignment main loop. */ - -static void -alpha_align_insns (unsigned int max_align, - rtx (*next_group) (rtx, int *, int *), - rtx (*next_nop) (int *)) -{ - /* ALIGN is the known alignment for the insn group. */ - unsigned int align; - /* OFS is the offset of the current insn in the insn group. */ - int ofs; - int prev_in_use, in_use, len, ldgp; - rtx i, next; - - /* Let shorten branches care for assigning alignments to code labels. */ - shorten_branches (get_insns ()); - - if (align_functions < 4) - align = 4; - else if ((unsigned int) align_functions < max_align) - align = align_functions; - else - align = max_align; - - ofs = prev_in_use = 0; - i = get_insns (); - if (GET_CODE (i) == NOTE) - i = next_nonnote_insn (i); - - ldgp = alpha_function_needs_gp ? 8 : 0; - - while (i) - { - next = (*next_group) (i, &in_use, &len); - - /* When we see a label, resync alignment etc. */ - if (GET_CODE (i) == CODE_LABEL) - { - unsigned int new_align = 1 << label_to_alignment (i); - - if (new_align >= align) - { - align = new_align < max_align ? new_align : max_align; - ofs = 0; - } - - else if (ofs & (new_align-1)) - ofs = (ofs | (new_align-1)) + 1; - if (len != 0) - abort(); - } - - /* Handle complex instructions special. */ - else if (in_use == 0) - { - /* Asms will have length < 0. This is a signal that we have - lost alignment knowledge. Assume, however, that the asm - will not mis-align instructions. */ - if (len < 0) - { - ofs = 0; - align = 4; - len = 0; - } - } - - /* If the known alignment is smaller than the recognized insn group, - realign the output. */ - else if ((int) align < len) - { - unsigned int new_log_align = len > 8 ? 4 : 3; - rtx prev, where; - - where = prev = prev_nonnote_insn (i); - if (!where || GET_CODE (where) != CODE_LABEL) - where = i; - - /* Can't realign between a call and its gp reload. */ - if (! (TARGET_EXPLICIT_RELOCS - && prev && GET_CODE (prev) == CALL_INSN)) - { - emit_insn_before (gen_realign (GEN_INT (new_log_align)), where); - align = 1 << new_log_align; - ofs = 0; - } - } - - /* We may not insert padding inside the initial ldgp sequence. */ - else if (ldgp > 0) - ldgp -= len; - - /* If the group won't fit in the same INT16 as the previous, - we need to add padding to keep the group together. Rather - than simply leaving the insn filling to the assembler, we - can make use of the knowledge of what sorts of instructions - were issued in the previous group to make sure that all of - the added nops are really free. */ - else if (ofs + len > (int) align) - { - int nop_count = (align - ofs) / 4; - rtx where; - - /* Insert nops before labels, branches, and calls to truly merge - the execution of the nops with the previous instruction group. */ - where = prev_nonnote_insn (i); - if (where) - { - if (GET_CODE (where) == CODE_LABEL) - { - rtx where2 = prev_nonnote_insn (where); - if (where2 && GET_CODE (where2) == JUMP_INSN) - where = where2; - } - else if (GET_CODE (where) == INSN) - where = i; - } - else - where = i; - - do - emit_insn_before ((*next_nop)(&prev_in_use), where); - while (--nop_count); - ofs = 0; - } - - ofs = (ofs + len) & (align - 1); - prev_in_use = in_use; - i = next; - } -} - -/* Machine dependent reorg pass. */ - -static void -alpha_reorg (void) -{ - if (alpha_tp != ALPHA_TP_PROG || flag_exceptions) - alpha_handle_trap_shadows (); - - /* Due to the number of extra trapb insns, don't bother fixing up - alignment when trap precision is instruction. Moreover, we can - only do our job when sched2 is run. */ - if (optimize && !optimize_size - && alpha_tp != ALPHA_TP_INSN - && flag_schedule_insns_after_reload) - { - if (alpha_cpu == PROCESSOR_EV4) - alpha_align_insns (8, alphaev4_next_group, alphaev4_next_nop); - else if (alpha_cpu == PROCESSOR_EV5) - alpha_align_insns (16, alphaev5_next_group, alphaev5_next_nop); - } -} - -#if !TARGET_ABI_UNICOSMK - -#ifdef HAVE_STAMP_H -#include <stamp.h> -#endif - -static void -alpha_file_start (void) -{ -#ifdef OBJECT_FORMAT_ELF - /* If emitting dwarf2 debug information, we cannot generate a .file - directive to start the file, as it will conflict with dwarf2out - file numbers. So it's only useful when emitting mdebug output. */ - targetm.file_start_file_directive = (write_symbols == DBX_DEBUG); -#endif - - default_file_start (); -#ifdef MS_STAMP - fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.verstamp %d %d\n", MS_STAMP, LS_STAMP); -#endif - - fputs ("\t.set noreorder\n", asm_out_file); - fputs ("\t.set volatile\n", asm_out_file); - if (!TARGET_ABI_OPEN_VMS) - fputs ("\t.set noat\n", asm_out_file); - if (TARGET_EXPLICIT_RELOCS) - fputs ("\t.set nomacro\n", asm_out_file); - if (TARGET_SUPPORT_ARCH | TARGET_BWX | TARGET_MAX | TARGET_FIX | TARGET_CIX) - fprintf (asm_out_file, - "\t.arch %s\n", - TARGET_CPU_EV6 ? "ev6" - : (TARGET_CPU_EV5 - ? (TARGET_MAX ? "pca56" : TARGET_BWX ? "ev56" : "ev5") - : "ev4")); -} -#endif - -#ifdef OBJECT_FORMAT_ELF - -/* Switch to the section to which we should output X. The only thing - special we do here is to honor small data. */ - -static void -alpha_elf_select_rtx_section (enum machine_mode mode, rtx x, - unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT align) -{ - if (TARGET_SMALL_DATA && GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) <= g_switch_value) - /* ??? Consider using mergeable sdata sections. */ - sdata_section (); - else - default_elf_select_rtx_section (mode, x, align); -} - -#endif /* OBJECT_FORMAT_ELF */ - -/* Structure to collect function names for final output in link section. */ -/* Note that items marked with GTY can't be ifdef'ed out. */ - -enum links_kind {KIND_UNUSED, KIND_LOCAL, KIND_EXTERN}; -enum reloc_kind {KIND_LINKAGE, KIND_CODEADDR}; - -struct alpha_links GTY(()) -{ - int num; - rtx linkage; - enum links_kind lkind; - enum reloc_kind rkind; -}; - -struct alpha_funcs GTY(()) -{ - int num; - splay_tree GTY ((param1_is (char *), param2_is (struct alpha_links *))) - links; -}; - -static GTY ((param1_is (char *), param2_is (struct alpha_links *))) - splay_tree alpha_links_tree; -static GTY ((param1_is (tree), param2_is (struct alpha_funcs *))) - splay_tree alpha_funcs_tree; - -static GTY(()) int alpha_funcs_num; - -#if TARGET_ABI_OPEN_VMS - -/* Return the VMS argument type corresponding to MODE. */ - -enum avms_arg_type -alpha_arg_type (enum machine_mode mode) -{ - switch (mode) - { - case SFmode: - return TARGET_FLOAT_VAX ? FF : FS; - case DFmode: - return TARGET_FLOAT_VAX ? FD : FT; - default: - return I64; - } -} - -/* Return an rtx for an integer representing the VMS Argument Information - register value. */ - -rtx -alpha_arg_info_reg_val (CUMULATIVE_ARGS cum) -{ - unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT regval = cum.num_args; - int i; - - for (i = 0; i < 6; i++) - regval |= ((int) cum.atypes[i]) << (i * 3 + 8); - - return GEN_INT (regval); -} - -/* Make (or fake) .linkage entry for function call. - - IS_LOCAL is 0 if name is used in call, 1 if name is used in definition. - - Return an SYMBOL_REF rtx for the linkage. */ - -rtx -alpha_need_linkage (const char *name, int is_local) -{ - splay_tree_node node; - struct alpha_links *al; - - if (name[0] == '*') - name++; - - if (is_local) - { - struct alpha_funcs *cfaf; - - if (!alpha_funcs_tree) - alpha_funcs_tree = splay_tree_new_ggc ((splay_tree_compare_fn) - splay_tree_compare_pointers); - - cfaf = (struct alpha_funcs *) ggc_alloc (sizeof (struct alpha_funcs)); - - cfaf->links = 0; - cfaf->num = ++alpha_funcs_num; - - splay_tree_insert (alpha_funcs_tree, - (splay_tree_key) current_function_decl, - (splay_tree_value) cfaf); - } - - if (alpha_links_tree) - { - /* Is this name already defined? */ - - node = splay_tree_lookup (alpha_links_tree, (splay_tree_key) name); - if (node) - { - al = (struct alpha_links *) node->value; - if (is_local) - { - /* Defined here but external assumed. */ - if (al->lkind == KIND_EXTERN) - al->lkind = KIND_LOCAL; - } - else - { - /* Used here but unused assumed. */ - if (al->lkind == KIND_UNUSED) - al->lkind = KIND_LOCAL; - } - return al->linkage; - } - } - else - alpha_links_tree = splay_tree_new_ggc ((splay_tree_compare_fn) strcmp); - - al = (struct alpha_links *) ggc_alloc (sizeof (struct alpha_links)); - name = ggc_strdup (name); - - /* Assume external if no definition. */ - al->lkind = (is_local ? KIND_UNUSED : KIND_EXTERN); - - /* Ensure we have an IDENTIFIER so assemble_name can mark it used. */ - get_identifier (name); - - /* Construct a SYMBOL_REF for us to call. */ - { - size_t name_len = strlen (name); - char *linksym = alloca (name_len + 6); - linksym[0] = '$'; - memcpy (linksym + 1, name, name_len); - memcpy (linksym + 1 + name_len, "..lk", 5); - al->linkage = gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode, - ggc_alloc_string (linksym, name_len + 5)); - } - - splay_tree_insert (alpha_links_tree, (splay_tree_key) name, - (splay_tree_value) al); - - return al->linkage; -} - -rtx -alpha_use_linkage (rtx linkage, tree cfundecl, int lflag, int rflag) -{ - splay_tree_node cfunnode; - struct alpha_funcs *cfaf; - struct alpha_links *al; - const char *name = XSTR (linkage, 0); - - cfaf = (struct alpha_funcs *) 0; - al = (struct alpha_links *) 0; - - cfunnode = splay_tree_lookup (alpha_funcs_tree, (splay_tree_key) cfundecl); - cfaf = (struct alpha_funcs *) cfunnode->value; - - if (cfaf->links) - { - splay_tree_node lnode; - - /* Is this name already defined? */ - - lnode = splay_tree_lookup (cfaf->links, (splay_tree_key) name); - if (lnode) - al = (struct alpha_links *) lnode->value; - } - else - cfaf->links = splay_tree_new_ggc ((splay_tree_compare_fn) strcmp); - - if (!al) - { - size_t name_len; - size_t buflen; - char buf [512]; - char *linksym; - splay_tree_node node = 0; - struct alpha_links *anl; - - if (name[0] == '*') - name++; - - name_len = strlen (name); - - al = (struct alpha_links *) ggc_alloc (sizeof (struct alpha_links)); - al->num = cfaf->num; - - node = splay_tree_lookup (alpha_links_tree, (splay_tree_key) name); - if (node) - { - anl = (struct alpha_links *) node->value; - al->lkind = anl->lkind; - } - - sprintf (buf, "$%d..%s..lk", cfaf->num, name); - buflen = strlen (buf); - linksym = alloca (buflen + 1); - memcpy (linksym, buf, buflen + 1); - - al->linkage = gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF - (Pmode, ggc_alloc_string (linksym, buflen + 1)); - - splay_tree_insert (cfaf->links, (splay_tree_key) name, - (splay_tree_value) al); - } - - if (rflag) - al->rkind = KIND_CODEADDR; - else - al->rkind = KIND_LINKAGE; - - if (lflag) - return gen_rtx_MEM (Pmode, plus_constant (al->linkage, 8)); - else - return al->linkage; -} - -static int -alpha_write_one_linkage (splay_tree_node node, void *data) -{ - const char *const name = (const char *) node->key; - struct alpha_links *link = (struct alpha_links *) node->value; - FILE *stream = (FILE *) data; - - fprintf (stream, "$%d..%s..lk:\n", link->num, name); - if (link->rkind == KIND_CODEADDR) - { - if (link->lkind == KIND_LOCAL) - { - /* Local and used */ - fprintf (stream, "\t.quad %s..en\n", name); - } - else - { - /* External and used, request code address. */ - fprintf (stream, "\t.code_address %s\n", name); - } - } - else - { - if (link->lkind == KIND_LOCAL) - { - /* Local and used, build linkage pair. */ - fprintf (stream, "\t.quad %s..en\n", name); - fprintf (stream, "\t.quad %s\n", name); - } - else - { - /* External and used, request linkage pair. */ - fprintf (stream, "\t.linkage %s\n", name); - } - } - - return 0; -} - -static void -alpha_write_linkage (FILE *stream, const char *funname, tree fundecl) -{ - splay_tree_node node; - struct alpha_funcs *func; - - link_section (); - fprintf (stream, "\t.align 3\n"); - node = splay_tree_lookup (alpha_funcs_tree, (splay_tree_key) fundecl); - func = (struct alpha_funcs *) node->value; - - fputs ("\t.name ", stream); - assemble_name (stream, funname); - fputs ("..na\n", stream); - ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (stream, funname); - fprintf (stream, "\t.pdesc "); - assemble_name (stream, funname); - fprintf (stream, "..en,%s\n", - alpha_procedure_type == PT_STACK ? "stack" - : alpha_procedure_type == PT_REGISTER ? "reg" : "null"); - - if (func->links) - { - splay_tree_foreach (func->links, alpha_write_one_linkage, stream); - /* splay_tree_delete (func->links); */ - } -} - -/* Given a decl, a section name, and whether the decl initializer - has relocs, choose attributes for the section. */ - -#define SECTION_VMS_OVERLAY SECTION_FORGET -#define SECTION_VMS_GLOBAL SECTION_MACH_DEP -#define SECTION_VMS_INITIALIZE (SECTION_VMS_GLOBAL << 1) - -static unsigned int -vms_section_type_flags (tree decl, const char *name, int reloc) -{ - unsigned int flags = default_section_type_flags (decl, name, reloc); - - if (decl && DECL_ATTRIBUTES (decl) - && lookup_attribute ("overlaid", DECL_ATTRIBUTES (decl))) - flags |= SECTION_VMS_OVERLAY; - if (decl && DECL_ATTRIBUTES (decl) - && lookup_attribute ("global", DECL_ATTRIBUTES (decl))) - flags |= SECTION_VMS_GLOBAL; - if (decl && DECL_ATTRIBUTES (decl) - && lookup_attribute ("initialize", DECL_ATTRIBUTES (decl))) - flags |= SECTION_VMS_INITIALIZE; - - return flags; -} - -/* Switch to an arbitrary section NAME with attributes as specified - by FLAGS. ALIGN specifies any known alignment requirements for - the section; 0 if the default should be used. */ - -static void -vms_asm_named_section (const char *name, unsigned int flags) -{ - fputc ('\n', asm_out_file); - fprintf (asm_out_file, ".section\t%s", name); - - if (flags & SECTION_VMS_OVERLAY) - fprintf (asm_out_file, ",OVR"); - if (flags & SECTION_VMS_GLOBAL) - fprintf (asm_out_file, ",GBL"); - if (flags & SECTION_VMS_INITIALIZE) - fprintf (asm_out_file, ",NOMOD"); - if (flags & SECTION_DEBUG) - fprintf (asm_out_file, ",NOWRT"); - - fputc ('\n', asm_out_file); -} - -/* Record an element in the table of global constructors. SYMBOL is - a SYMBOL_REF of the function to be called; PRIORITY is a number - between 0 and MAX_INIT_PRIORITY. - - Differs from default_ctors_section_asm_out_constructor in that the - width of the .ctors entry is always 64 bits, rather than the 32 bits - used by a normal pointer. */ - -static void -vms_asm_out_constructor (rtx symbol, int priority ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED) -{ - ctors_section (); - assemble_align (BITS_PER_WORD); - assemble_integer (symbol, UNITS_PER_WORD, BITS_PER_WORD, 1); -} - -static void -vms_asm_out_destructor (rtx symbol, int priority ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED) -{ - dtors_section (); - assemble_align (BITS_PER_WORD); - assemble_integer (symbol, UNITS_PER_WORD, BITS_PER_WORD, 1); -} -#else - -rtx -alpha_need_linkage (const char *name ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, - int is_local ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED) -{ - return NULL_RTX; -} - -rtx -alpha_use_linkage (rtx linkage ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, - tree cfundecl ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, - int lflag ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, - int rflag ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED) -{ - return NULL_RTX; -} - -#endif /* TARGET_ABI_OPEN_VMS */ - -#if TARGET_ABI_UNICOSMK - -/* Define the offset between two registers, one to be eliminated, and the - other its replacement, at the start of a routine. */ - -int -unicosmk_initial_elimination_offset (int from, int to) -{ - int fixed_size; - - fixed_size = alpha_sa_size(); - if (fixed_size != 0) - fixed_size += 48; - - if (from == FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM && to == HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM) - return -fixed_size; - else if (from == ARG_POINTER_REGNUM && to == HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM) - return 0; - else if (from == FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM && to == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM) - return (ALPHA_ROUND (current_function_outgoing_args_size) - + ALPHA_ROUND (get_frame_size())); - else if (from == ARG_POINTER_REGNUM && to == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM) - return (ALPHA_ROUND (fixed_size) - + ALPHA_ROUND (get_frame_size() - + current_function_outgoing_args_size)); - else - abort (); -} - -/* Output the module name for .ident and .end directives. We have to strip - directories and add make sure that the module name starts with a letter - or '$'. */ - -static void -unicosmk_output_module_name (FILE *file) -{ - const char *name = lbasename (main_input_filename); - unsigned len = strlen (name); - char *clean_name = alloca (len + 2); - char *ptr = clean_name; - - /* CAM only accepts module names that start with a letter or '$'. We - prefix the module name with a '$' if necessary. */ - - if (!ISALPHA (*name)) - *ptr++ = '$'; - memcpy (ptr, name, len + 1); - clean_symbol_name (clean_name); - fputs (clean_name, file); -} - -/* Output the definition of a common variable. */ - -void -unicosmk_output_common (FILE *file, const char *name, int size, int align) -{ - tree name_tree; - printf ("T3E__: common %s\n", name); - - common_section (); - fputs("\t.endp\n\n\t.psect ", file); - assemble_name(file, name); - fprintf(file, ",%d,common\n", floor_log2 (align / BITS_PER_UNIT)); - fprintf(file, "\t.byte\t0:%d\n", size); - - /* Mark the symbol as defined in this module. */ - name_tree = get_identifier (name); - TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (name_tree) = 1; -} - -#define SECTION_PUBLIC SECTION_MACH_DEP -#define SECTION_MAIN (SECTION_PUBLIC << 1) -static int current_section_align; - -static unsigned int -unicosmk_section_type_flags (tree decl, const char *name, - int reloc ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED) -{ - unsigned int flags = default_section_type_flags (decl, name, reloc); - - if (!decl) - return flags; - - if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL) - { - current_section_align = floor_log2 (FUNCTION_BOUNDARY / BITS_PER_UNIT); - if (align_functions_log > current_section_align) - current_section_align = align_functions_log; - - if (! strcmp (IDENTIFIER_POINTER (DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (decl)), "main")) - flags |= SECTION_MAIN; - } - else - current_section_align = floor_log2 (DECL_ALIGN (decl) / BITS_PER_UNIT); - - if (TREE_PUBLIC (decl)) - flags |= SECTION_PUBLIC; - - return flags; -} - -/* Generate a section name for decl and associate it with the - declaration. */ - -static void -unicosmk_unique_section (tree decl, int reloc ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED) -{ - const char *name; - int len; - - if (!decl) - abort (); - - name = IDENTIFIER_POINTER (DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (decl)); - name = default_strip_name_encoding (name); - len = strlen (name); - - if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL) - { - char *string; - - /* It is essential that we prefix the section name here because - otherwise the section names generated for constructors and - destructors confuse collect2. */ - - string = alloca (len + 6); - sprintf (string, "code@%s", name); - DECL_SECTION_NAME (decl) = build_string (len + 5, string); - } - else if (TREE_PUBLIC (decl)) - DECL_SECTION_NAME (decl) = build_string (len, name); - else - { - char *string; - - string = alloca (len + 6); - sprintf (string, "data@%s", name); - DECL_SECTION_NAME (decl) = build_string (len + 5, string); - } -} - -/* Switch to an arbitrary section NAME with attributes as specified - by FLAGS. ALIGN specifies any known alignment requirements for - the section; 0 if the default should be used. */ - -static void -unicosmk_asm_named_section (const char *name, unsigned int flags) -{ - const char *kind; - - /* Close the previous section. */ - - fputs ("\t.endp\n\n", asm_out_file); - - /* Find out what kind of section we are opening. */ - - if (flags & SECTION_MAIN) - fputs ("\t.start\tmain\n", asm_out_file); - - if (flags & SECTION_CODE) - kind = "code"; - else if (flags & SECTION_PUBLIC) - kind = "common"; - else - kind = "data"; - - if (current_section_align != 0) - fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.psect\t%s,%d,%s\n", name, - current_section_align, kind); - else - fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.psect\t%s,%s\n", name, kind); -} - -static void -unicosmk_insert_attributes (tree decl, tree *attr_ptr ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED) -{ - if (DECL_P (decl) - && (TREE_PUBLIC (decl) || TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL)) - unicosmk_unique_section (decl, 0); -} - -/* Output an alignment directive. We have to use the macro 'gcc@code@align' - in code sections because .align fill unused space with zeroes. */ - -void -unicosmk_output_align (FILE *file, int align) -{ - if (inside_function) - fprintf (file, "\tgcc@code@align\t%d\n", align); - else - fprintf (file, "\t.align\t%d\n", align); -} - -/* Add a case vector to the current function's list of deferred case - vectors. Case vectors have to be put into a separate section because CAM - does not allow data definitions in code sections. */ - -void -unicosmk_defer_case_vector (rtx lab, rtx vec) -{ - struct machine_function *machine = cfun->machine; - - vec = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (VOIDmode, lab, vec); - machine->addr_list = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (VOIDmode, vec, - machine->addr_list); -} - -/* Output a case vector. */ - -static void -unicosmk_output_addr_vec (FILE *file, rtx vec) -{ - rtx lab = XEXP (vec, 0); - rtx body = XEXP (vec, 1); - int vlen = XVECLEN (body, 0); - int idx; - - (*targetm.asm_out.internal_label) (file, "L", CODE_LABEL_NUMBER (lab)); - - for (idx = 0; idx < vlen; idx++) - { - ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_VEC_ELT - (file, CODE_LABEL_NUMBER (XEXP (XVECEXP (body, 0, idx), 0))); - } -} - -/* Output current function's deferred case vectors. */ - -static void -unicosmk_output_deferred_case_vectors (FILE *file) -{ - struct machine_function *machine = cfun->machine; - rtx t; - - if (machine->addr_list == NULL_RTX) - return; - - data_section (); - for (t = machine->addr_list; t; t = XEXP (t, 1)) - unicosmk_output_addr_vec (file, XEXP (t, 0)); -} - -/* Generate the name of the SSIB section for the current function. */ - -#define SSIB_PREFIX "__SSIB_" -#define SSIB_PREFIX_LEN 7 - -static const char * -unicosmk_ssib_name (void) -{ - /* This is ok since CAM won't be able to deal with names longer than that - anyway. */ - - static char name[256]; - - rtx x; - const char *fnname; - int len; - - x = DECL_RTL (cfun->decl); - if (GET_CODE (x) != MEM) - abort (); - x = XEXP (x, 0); - if (GET_CODE (x) != SYMBOL_REF) - abort (); - fnname = XSTR (x, 0); - - len = strlen (fnname); - if (len + SSIB_PREFIX_LEN > 255) - len = 255 - SSIB_PREFIX_LEN; - - strcpy (name, SSIB_PREFIX); - strncpy (name + SSIB_PREFIX_LEN, fnname, len); - name[len + SSIB_PREFIX_LEN] = 0; - - return name; -} - -/* Set up the dynamic subprogram information block (DSIB) and update the - frame pointer register ($15) for subroutines which have a frame. If the - subroutine doesn't have a frame, simply increment $15. */ - -static void -unicosmk_gen_dsib (unsigned long *imaskP) -{ - if (alpha_procedure_type == PT_STACK) - { - const char *ssib_name; - rtx mem; - - /* Allocate 64 bytes for the DSIB. */ - - FRP (emit_insn (gen_adddi3 (stack_pointer_rtx, stack_pointer_rtx, - GEN_INT (-64)))); - emit_insn (gen_blockage ()); - - /* Save the return address. */ - - mem = gen_rtx_MEM (DImode, plus_constant (stack_pointer_rtx, 56)); - set_mem_alias_set (mem, alpha_sr_alias_set); - FRP (emit_move_insn (mem, gen_rtx_REG (DImode, REG_RA))); - (*imaskP) &= ~(1UL << REG_RA); - - /* Save the old frame pointer. */ - - mem = gen_rtx_MEM (DImode, plus_constant (stack_pointer_rtx, 48)); - set_mem_alias_set (mem, alpha_sr_alias_set); - FRP (emit_move_insn (mem, hard_frame_pointer_rtx)); - (*imaskP) &= ~(1UL << HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM); - - emit_insn (gen_blockage ()); - - /* Store the SSIB pointer. */ - - ssib_name = ggc_strdup (unicosmk_ssib_name ()); - mem = gen_rtx_MEM (DImode, plus_constant (stack_pointer_rtx, 32)); - set_mem_alias_set (mem, alpha_sr_alias_set); - - FRP (emit_move_insn (gen_rtx_REG (DImode, 5), - gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode, ssib_name))); - FRP (emit_move_insn (mem, gen_rtx_REG (DImode, 5))); - - /* Save the CIW index. */ - - mem = gen_rtx_MEM (DImode, plus_constant (stack_pointer_rtx, 24)); - set_mem_alias_set (mem, alpha_sr_alias_set); - FRP (emit_move_insn (mem, gen_rtx_REG (DImode, 25))); - - emit_insn (gen_blockage ()); - - /* Set the new frame pointer. */ - - FRP (emit_insn (gen_adddi3 (hard_frame_pointer_rtx, - stack_pointer_rtx, GEN_INT (64)))); - - } - else - { - /* Increment the frame pointer register to indicate that we do not - have a frame. */ - - FRP (emit_insn (gen_adddi3 (hard_frame_pointer_rtx, - hard_frame_pointer_rtx, GEN_INT (1)))); - } -} - -/* Output the static subroutine information block for the current - function. */ - -static void -unicosmk_output_ssib (FILE *file, const char *fnname) -{ - int len; - int i; - rtx x; - rtx ciw; - struct machine_function *machine = cfun->machine; - - ssib_section (); - fprintf (file, "\t.endp\n\n\t.psect\t%s%s,data\n", user_label_prefix, - unicosmk_ssib_name ()); - - /* Some required stuff and the function name length. */ - - len = strlen (fnname); - fprintf (file, "\t.quad\t^X20008%2.2X28\n", len); - - /* Saved registers - ??? We don't do that yet. */ - - fputs ("\t.quad\t0\n", file); - - /* Function address. */ - - fputs ("\t.quad\t", file); - assemble_name (file, fnname); - putc ('\n', file); - - fputs ("\t.quad\t0\n", file); - fputs ("\t.quad\t0\n", file); - - /* Function name. - ??? We do it the same way Cray CC does it but this could be - simplified. */ - - for( i = 0; i < len; i++ ) - fprintf (file, "\t.byte\t%d\n", (int)(fnname[i])); - if( (len % 8) == 0 ) - fputs ("\t.quad\t0\n", file); - else - fprintf (file, "\t.bits\t%d : 0\n", (8 - (len % 8))*8); - - /* All call information words used in the function. */ - - for (x = machine->first_ciw; x; x = XEXP (x, 1)) - { - ciw = XEXP (x, 0); -#if HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 32 - fprintf (file, "\t.quad\t" HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DOUBLE_HEX "\n", - CONST_DOUBLE_HIGH (ciw), CONST_DOUBLE_LOW (ciw)); -#else - fprintf (file, "\t.quad\t" HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_HEX "\n", INTVAL (ciw)); -#endif - } -} - -/* Add a call information word (CIW) to the list of the current function's - CIWs and return its index. - - X is a CONST_INT or CONST_DOUBLE representing the CIW. */ - -rtx -unicosmk_add_call_info_word (rtx x) -{ - rtx node; - struct machine_function *machine = cfun->machine; - - node = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (VOIDmode, x, NULL_RTX); - if (machine->first_ciw == NULL_RTX) - machine->first_ciw = node; - else - XEXP (machine->last_ciw, 1) = node; - - machine->last_ciw = node; - ++machine->ciw_count; - - return GEN_INT (machine->ciw_count - + strlen (current_function_name ())/8 + 5); -} - -static char unicosmk_section_buf[100]; - -char * -unicosmk_text_section (void) -{ - static int count = 0; - sprintf (unicosmk_section_buf, "\t.endp\n\n\t.psect\tgcc@text___%d,code", - count++); - return unicosmk_section_buf; -} - -char * -unicosmk_data_section (void) -{ - static int count = 1; - sprintf (unicosmk_section_buf, "\t.endp\n\n\t.psect\tgcc@data___%d,data", - count++); - return unicosmk_section_buf; -} - -/* The Cray assembler doesn't accept extern declarations for symbols which - are defined in the same file. We have to keep track of all global - symbols which are referenced and/or defined in a source file and output - extern declarations for those which are referenced but not defined at - the end of file. */ - -/* List of identifiers for which an extern declaration might have to be - emitted. */ -/* FIXME: needs to use GC, so it can be saved and restored for PCH. */ - -struct unicosmk_extern_list -{ - struct unicosmk_extern_list *next; - const char *name; -}; - -static struct unicosmk_extern_list *unicosmk_extern_head = 0; - -/* Output extern declarations which are required for every asm file. */ - -static void -unicosmk_output_default_externs (FILE *file) -{ - static const char *const externs[] = - { "__T3E_MISMATCH" }; - - int i; - int n; - - n = ARRAY_SIZE (externs); - - for (i = 0; i < n; i++) - fprintf (file, "\t.extern\t%s\n", externs[i]); -} - -/* Output extern declarations for global symbols which are have been - referenced but not defined. */ - -static void -unicosmk_output_externs (FILE *file) -{ - struct unicosmk_extern_list *p; - const char *real_name; - int len; - tree name_tree; - - len = strlen (user_label_prefix); - for (p = unicosmk_extern_head; p != 0; p = p->next) - { - /* We have to strip the encoding and possibly remove user_label_prefix - from the identifier in order to handle -fleading-underscore and - explicit asm names correctly (cf. gcc.dg/asm-names-1.c). */ - real_name = default_strip_name_encoding (p->name); - if (len && p->name[0] == '*' - && !memcmp (real_name, user_label_prefix, len)) - real_name += len; - - name_tree = get_identifier (real_name); - if (! TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (name_tree)) - { - TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (name_tree) = 1; - fputs ("\t.extern\t", file); - assemble_name (file, p->name); - putc ('\n', file); - } - } -} - -/* Record an extern. */ - -void -unicosmk_add_extern (const char *name) -{ - struct unicosmk_extern_list *p; - - p = (struct unicosmk_extern_list *) - xmalloc (sizeof (struct unicosmk_extern_list)); - p->next = unicosmk_extern_head; - p->name = name; - unicosmk_extern_head = p; -} - -/* The Cray assembler generates incorrect code if identifiers which - conflict with register names are used as instruction operands. We have - to replace such identifiers with DEX expressions. */ - -/* Structure to collect identifiers which have been replaced by DEX - expressions. */ -/* FIXME: needs to use GC, so it can be saved and restored for PCH. */ - -struct unicosmk_dex { - struct unicosmk_dex *next; - const char *name; -}; - -/* List of identifiers which have been replaced by DEX expressions. The DEX - number is determined by the position in the list. */ - -static struct unicosmk_dex *unicosmk_dex_list = NULL; - -/* The number of elements in the DEX list. */ - -static int unicosmk_dex_count = 0; - -/* Check if NAME must be replaced by a DEX expression. */ - -static int -unicosmk_special_name (const char *name) -{ - if (name[0] == '*') - ++name; - - if (name[0] == '$') - ++name; - - if (name[0] != 'r' && name[0] != 'f' && name[0] != 'R' && name[0] != 'F') - return 0; - - switch (name[1]) - { - case '1': case '2': - return (name[2] == '\0' || (ISDIGIT (name[2]) && name[3] == '\0')); - - case '3': - return (name[2] == '\0' - || ((name[2] == '0' || name[2] == '1') && name[3] == '\0')); - - default: - return (ISDIGIT (name[1]) && name[2] == '\0'); - } -} - -/* Return the DEX number if X must be replaced by a DEX expression and 0 - otherwise. */ - -static int -unicosmk_need_dex (rtx x) -{ - struct unicosmk_dex *dex; - const char *name; - int i; - - if (GET_CODE (x) != SYMBOL_REF) - return 0; - - name = XSTR (x,0); - if (! unicosmk_special_name (name)) - return 0; - - i = unicosmk_dex_count; - for (dex = unicosmk_dex_list; dex; dex = dex->next) - { - if (! strcmp (name, dex->name)) - return i; - --i; - } - - dex = (struct unicosmk_dex *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct unicosmk_dex)); - dex->name = name; - dex->next = unicosmk_dex_list; - unicosmk_dex_list = dex; - - ++unicosmk_dex_count; - return unicosmk_dex_count; -} - -/* Output the DEX definitions for this file. */ - -static void -unicosmk_output_dex (FILE *file) -{ - struct unicosmk_dex *dex; - int i; - - if (unicosmk_dex_list == NULL) - return; - - fprintf (file, "\t.dexstart\n"); - - i = unicosmk_dex_count; - for (dex = unicosmk_dex_list; dex; dex = dex->next) - { - fprintf (file, "\tDEX (%d) = ", i); - assemble_name (file, dex->name); - putc ('\n', file); - --i; - } - - fprintf (file, "\t.dexend\n"); -} - -/* Output text that to appear at the beginning of an assembler file. */ - -static void -unicosmk_file_start (void) -{ - int i; - - fputs ("\t.ident\t", asm_out_file); - unicosmk_output_module_name (asm_out_file); - fputs ("\n\n", asm_out_file); - - /* The Unicos/Mk assembler uses different register names. Instead of trying - to support them, we simply use micro definitions. */ - - /* CAM has different register names: rN for the integer register N and fN - for the floating-point register N. Instead of trying to use these in - alpha.md, we define the symbols $N and $fN to refer to the appropriate - register. */ - - for (i = 0; i < 32; ++i) - fprintf (asm_out_file, "$%d <- r%d\n", i, i); - - for (i = 0; i < 32; ++i) - fprintf (asm_out_file, "$f%d <- f%d\n", i, i); - - putc ('\n', asm_out_file); - - /* The .align directive fill unused space with zeroes which does not work - in code sections. We define the macro 'gcc@code@align' which uses nops - instead. Note that it assumes that code sections always have the - biggest possible alignment since . refers to the current offset from - the beginning of the section. */ - - fputs ("\t.macro gcc@code@align n\n", asm_out_file); - fputs ("gcc@n@bytes = 1 << n\n", asm_out_file); - fputs ("gcc@here = . % gcc@n@bytes\n", asm_out_file); - fputs ("\t.if ne, gcc@here, 0\n", asm_out_file); - fputs ("\t.repeat (gcc@n@bytes - gcc@here) / 4\n", asm_out_file); - fputs ("\tbis r31,r31,r31\n", asm_out_file); - fputs ("\t.endr\n", asm_out_file); - fputs ("\t.endif\n", asm_out_file); - fputs ("\t.endm gcc@code@align\n\n", asm_out_file); - - /* Output extern declarations which should always be visible. */ - unicosmk_output_default_externs (asm_out_file); - - /* Open a dummy section. We always need to be inside a section for the - section-switching code to work correctly. - ??? This should be a module id or something like that. I still have to - figure out what the rules for those are. */ - fputs ("\n\t.psect\t$SG00000,data\n", asm_out_file); -} - -/* Output text to appear at the end of an assembler file. This includes all - pending extern declarations and DEX expressions. */ - -static void -unicosmk_file_end (void) -{ - fputs ("\t.endp\n\n", asm_out_file); - - /* Output all pending externs. */ - - unicosmk_output_externs (asm_out_file); - - /* Output dex definitions used for functions whose names conflict with - register names. */ - - unicosmk_output_dex (asm_out_file); - - fputs ("\t.end\t", asm_out_file); - unicosmk_output_module_name (asm_out_file); - putc ('\n', asm_out_file); -} - -#else - -static void -unicosmk_output_deferred_case_vectors (FILE *file ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED) -{} - -static void -unicosmk_gen_dsib (unsigned long *imaskP ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED) -{} - -static void -unicosmk_output_ssib (FILE * file ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, - const char * fnname ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED) -{} - -rtx -unicosmk_add_call_info_word (rtx x ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED) -{ - return NULL_RTX; -} - -static int -unicosmk_need_dex (rtx x ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED) -{ - return 0; -} - -#endif /* TARGET_ABI_UNICOSMK */ - -static void -alpha_init_libfuncs (void) -{ - if (TARGET_ABI_UNICOSMK) - { - /* Prevent gcc from generating calls to __divsi3. */ - set_optab_libfunc (sdiv_optab, SImode, 0); - set_optab_libfunc (udiv_optab, SImode, 0); - - /* Use the functions provided by the system library - for DImode integer division. */ - set_optab_libfunc (sdiv_optab, DImode, "$sldiv"); - set_optab_libfunc (udiv_optab, DImode, "$uldiv"); - } - else if (TARGET_ABI_OPEN_VMS) - { - /* Use the VMS runtime library functions for division and - remainder. */ - set_optab_libfunc (sdiv_optab, SImode, "OTS$DIV_I"); - set_optab_libfunc (sdiv_optab, DImode, "OTS$DIV_L"); - set_optab_libfunc (udiv_optab, SImode, "OTS$DIV_UI"); - set_optab_libfunc (udiv_optab, DImode, "OTS$DIV_UL"); - set_optab_libfunc (smod_optab, SImode, "OTS$REM_I"); - set_optab_libfunc (smod_optab, DImode, "OTS$REM_L"); - set_optab_libfunc (umod_optab, SImode, "OTS$REM_UI"); - set_optab_libfunc (umod_optab, DImode, "OTS$REM_UL"); - } -} - - -/* Initialize the GCC target structure. */ -#if TARGET_ABI_OPEN_VMS -# undef TARGET_ATTRIBUTE_TABLE -# define TARGET_ATTRIBUTE_TABLE vms_attribute_table -# undef TARGET_SECTION_TYPE_FLAGS -# define TARGET_SECTION_TYPE_FLAGS vms_section_type_flags -#endif - -#undef TARGET_IN_SMALL_DATA_P -#define TARGET_IN_SMALL_DATA_P alpha_in_small_data_p - -#if TARGET_ABI_UNICOSMK -# undef TARGET_INSERT_ATTRIBUTES -# define TARGET_INSERT_ATTRIBUTES unicosmk_insert_attributes -# undef TARGET_SECTION_TYPE_FLAGS -# define TARGET_SECTION_TYPE_FLAGS unicosmk_section_type_flags -# undef TARGET_ASM_UNIQUE_SECTION -# define TARGET_ASM_UNIQUE_SECTION unicosmk_unique_section -# undef TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_LABEL -# define TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_LABEL hook_void_FILEptr_constcharptr -#endif - -#undef TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_HI_OP -#define TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_HI_OP "\t.word\t" -#undef TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_DI_OP -#define TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_DI_OP "\t.quad\t" - -/* Default unaligned ops are provided for ELF systems. To get unaligned - data for non-ELF systems, we have to turn off auto alignment. */ -#ifndef OBJECT_FORMAT_ELF -#undef TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_HI_OP -#define TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_HI_OP "\t.align 0\n\t.word\t" -#undef TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_SI_OP -#define TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_SI_OP "\t.align 0\n\t.long\t" -#undef TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_DI_OP -#define TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_DI_OP "\t.align 0\n\t.quad\t" -#endif - -#ifdef OBJECT_FORMAT_ELF -#undef TARGET_ASM_SELECT_RTX_SECTION -#define TARGET_ASM_SELECT_RTX_SECTION alpha_elf_select_rtx_section -#endif - -#undef TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_END_PROLOGUE -#define TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_END_PROLOGUE alpha_output_function_end_prologue - -#undef TARGET_INIT_LIBFUNCS -#define TARGET_INIT_LIBFUNCS alpha_init_libfuncs - -#if TARGET_ABI_UNICOSMK -#undef TARGET_ASM_FILE_START -#define TARGET_ASM_FILE_START unicosmk_file_start -#undef TARGET_ASM_FILE_END -#define TARGET_ASM_FILE_END unicosmk_file_end -#else -#undef TARGET_ASM_FILE_START -#define TARGET_ASM_FILE_START alpha_file_start -#undef TARGET_ASM_FILE_START_FILE_DIRECTIVE -#define TARGET_ASM_FILE_START_FILE_DIRECTIVE true -#endif - -#undef TARGET_SCHED_ADJUST_COST -#define TARGET_SCHED_ADJUST_COST alpha_adjust_cost -#undef TARGET_SCHED_ISSUE_RATE -#define TARGET_SCHED_ISSUE_RATE alpha_issue_rate -#undef TARGET_SCHED_USE_DFA_PIPELINE_INTERFACE -#define TARGET_SCHED_USE_DFA_PIPELINE_INTERFACE \ - alpha_use_dfa_pipeline_interface -#undef TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD -#define TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD \ - alpha_multipass_dfa_lookahead - -#undef TARGET_HAVE_TLS -#define TARGET_HAVE_TLS HAVE_AS_TLS - -#undef TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS -#define TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS alpha_init_builtins -#undef TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN -#define TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN alpha_expand_builtin - -#undef TARGET_FUNCTION_OK_FOR_SIBCALL -#define TARGET_FUNCTION_OK_FOR_SIBCALL alpha_function_ok_for_sibcall -#undef TARGET_CANNOT_COPY_INSN_P -#define TARGET_CANNOT_COPY_INSN_P alpha_cannot_copy_insn_p -#undef TARGET_CANNOT_FORCE_CONST_MEM -#define TARGET_CANNOT_FORCE_CONST_MEM alpha_cannot_force_const_mem - -#if TARGET_ABI_OSF -#undef TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK -#define TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK alpha_output_mi_thunk_osf -#undef TARGET_ASM_CAN_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK -#define TARGET_ASM_CAN_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK hook_bool_tree_hwi_hwi_tree_true -#endif - -#undef TARGET_RTX_COSTS -#define TARGET_RTX_COSTS alpha_rtx_costs -#undef TARGET_ADDRESS_COST -#define TARGET_ADDRESS_COST hook_int_rtx_0 - -#undef TARGET_MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG -#define TARGET_MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG alpha_reorg - -#undef TARGET_PROMOTE_FUNCTION_ARGS -#define TARGET_PROMOTE_FUNCTION_ARGS hook_bool_tree_true -#undef TARGET_PROMOTE_FUNCTION_RETURN -#define TARGET_PROMOTE_FUNCTION_RETURN hook_bool_tree_true -#undef TARGET_PROMOTE_PROTOTYPES -#define TARGET_PROMOTE_PROTOTYPES hook_bool_tree_false -#undef TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX -#define TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX hook_rtx_tree_int_null -#undef TARGET_RETURN_IN_MEMORY -#define TARGET_RETURN_IN_MEMORY alpha_return_in_memory -#undef TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS -#define TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS alpha_setup_incoming_varargs -#undef TARGET_STRICT_ARGUMENT_NAMING -#define TARGET_STRICT_ARGUMENT_NAMING hook_bool_CUMULATIVE_ARGS_true -#undef TARGET_PRETEND_OUTGOING_VARARGS_NAMED -#define TARGET_PRETEND_OUTGOING_VARARGS_NAMED hook_bool_CUMULATIVE_ARGS_true -#undef TARGET_SPLIT_COMPLEX_ARG -#define TARGET_SPLIT_COMPLEX_ARG alpha_split_complex_arg - -#undef TARGET_BUILD_BUILTIN_VA_LIST -#define TARGET_BUILD_BUILTIN_VA_LIST alpha_build_builtin_va_list - -struct gcc_target targetm = TARGET_INITIALIZER; - - -#include "gt-alpha.h" |